# SOME DESCRIPTIVE TITLE # Copyright (C) YEAR Red Hat # This file is distributed under the same license as the sssd-docs package. # # Translators: # Wijnand Modderman-Lenstra , 2011 msgid "" msgstr "" "Project-Id-Version: SSSD\n" "Report-Msgid-Bugs-To: sssd-devel@redhat.com\n" "POT-Creation-Date: 2014-10-20 16:36+0300\n" "PO-Revision-Date: 2014-06-04 18:04+0000\n" "Last-Translator: jhrozek \n" "Language-Team: Dutch (http://www.transifex.com/projects/p/sssd/language/" "nl/)\n" "Language: nl\n" "MIME-Version: 1.0\n" "Content-Type: text/plain; charset=UTF-8\n" "Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit\n" "Plural-Forms: nplurals=2; plural=(n != 1);\n" #. type: Content of: #: sss_groupmod.8.xml:5 sssd.conf.5.xml:5 sssd-ldap.5.xml:5 pam_sss.8.xml:5 #: sssd_krb5_locator_plugin.8.xml:5 sssd-simple.5.xml:5 sssd-ipa.5.xml:5 #: sssd-ad.5.xml:5 sssd-sudo.5.xml:5 sssd.8.xml:5 sss_obfuscate.8.xml:5 #: sss_useradd.8.xml:5 sssd-krb5.5.xml:5 sss_groupadd.8.xml:5 #: sss_userdel.8.xml:5 sss_groupdel.8.xml:5 sss_groupshow.8.xml:5 #: sss_usermod.8.xml:5 sss_cache.8.xml:5 sss_debuglevel.8.xml:5 #: sss_seed.8.xml:5 sssd-ifp.5.xml:5 sss_rpcidmapd.5.xml:5 #: sss_ssh_authorizedkeys.1.xml:5 sss_ssh_knownhostsproxy.1.xml:5 msgid "SSSD Manual pages" msgstr "SSSD handleiding" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refname> #: sss_groupmod.8.xml:10 sss_groupmod.8.xml:15 msgid "sss_groupmod" msgstr "sss_groupmod" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refmeta><manvolnum> #: sss_groupmod.8.xml:11 pam_sss.8.xml:14 sssd_krb5_locator_plugin.8.xml:11 #: sssd.8.xml:11 sss_obfuscate.8.xml:11 sss_useradd.8.xml:11 #: sss_groupadd.8.xml:11 sss_userdel.8.xml:11 sss_groupdel.8.xml:11 #: sss_groupshow.8.xml:11 sss_usermod.8.xml:11 sss_cache.8.xml:11 #: sss_debuglevel.8.xml:11 sss_seed.8.xml:11 msgid "8" msgstr "8" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refpurpose> #: sss_groupmod.8.xml:16 msgid "modify a group" msgstr "muteer een groep" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsynopsisdiv><cmdsynopsis> #: sss_groupmod.8.xml:21 msgid "" "<command>sss_groupmod</command> <arg choice='opt'> <replaceable>options</" "replaceable> </arg> <arg choice='plain'><replaceable>GROUP</replaceable></" "arg>" msgstr "" "<command>sss_groupmod</command> <arg choice='opt'> <replaceable>opties</" "replaceable> </arg> <arg choice='plain'><replaceable>GROEP</replaceable></" "arg>" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><title> #: sss_groupmod.8.xml:30 sssd-ldap.5.xml:21 pam_sss.8.xml:53 #: sssd_krb5_locator_plugin.8.xml:20 sssd-simple.5.xml:22 sssd-ipa.5.xml:21 #: sssd-ad.5.xml:21 sssd-sudo.5.xml:21 sssd.8.xml:29 sss_obfuscate.8.xml:30 #: sss_useradd.8.xml:30 sssd-krb5.5.xml:21 sss_groupadd.8.xml:30 #: sss_userdel.8.xml:30 sss_groupdel.8.xml:30 sss_groupshow.8.xml:30 #: sss_usermod.8.xml:30 sss_cache.8.xml:29 sss_debuglevel.8.xml:30 #: sss_seed.8.xml:31 sssd-ifp.5.xml:21 sss_ssh_authorizedkeys.1.xml:30 #: sss_ssh_knownhostsproxy.1.xml:31 msgid "DESCRIPTION" msgstr "OMSCHRIJVING" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sss_groupmod.8.xml:32 msgid "" "<command>sss_groupmod</command> modifies the group to reflect the changes " "that are specified on the command line." msgstr "" "<command>sss_groupmod</command> muteert de groep en maakt de aanpassingen " "die via de opdrachtregel ingegeven zijn." #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><title> #: sss_groupmod.8.xml:39 pam_sss.8.xml:60 sssd.8.xml:42 sss_obfuscate.8.xml:58 #: sss_useradd.8.xml:39 sss_groupadd.8.xml:39 sss_userdel.8.xml:39 #: sss_groupdel.8.xml:39 sss_groupshow.8.xml:39 sss_usermod.8.xml:39 #: sss_cache.8.xml:38 sss_debuglevel.8.xml:38 sss_seed.8.xml:42 #: sss_ssh_authorizedkeys.1.xml:75 sss_ssh_knownhostsproxy.1.xml:62 msgid "OPTIONS" msgstr "OPTIES" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sss_groupmod.8.xml:43 sss_usermod.8.xml:77 msgid "" "<option>-a</option>,<option>--append-group</option> <replaceable>GROUPS</" "replaceable>" msgstr "" "<option>-a</option>,<option>--append-group</option> <replaceable>GROEPEN</" "replaceable>" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_groupmod.8.xml:48 msgid "" "Append this group to groups specified by the <replaceable>GROUPS</" "replaceable> parameter. The <replaceable>GROUPS</replaceable> parameter is " "a comma separated list of group names." msgstr "" "Voeg deze groep toe aan de groepen opgegeven met de <replaceable>GROEPEN</" "replaceable> parameter. De <replaceable>GROEPEN</replaceable> parameter is " "een kommagescheiden lijst van groepnamen." #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sss_groupmod.8.xml:57 sss_usermod.8.xml:91 msgid "" "<option>-r</option>,<option>--remove-group</option> <replaceable>GROUPS</" "replaceable>" msgstr "" "<option>-r</option>,<option>--remove-group</option> <replaceable>GROEPEN</" "replaceable>" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_groupmod.8.xml:62 msgid "" "Remove this group from groups specified by the <replaceable>GROUPS</" "replaceable> parameter." msgstr "" "Verwijder deze groep uit de groepen opgegeven in de <replaceable>GROEPEN</" "replaceable> parameter." #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refname> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:10 sssd.conf.5.xml:16 msgid "sssd.conf" msgstr "sssd.conf" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refmeta><manvolnum> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:11 sssd-ldap.5.xml:11 sssd-simple.5.xml:11 #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:11 sssd-ad.5.xml:11 sssd-sudo.5.xml:11 sssd-krb5.5.xml:11 #: sssd-ifp.5.xml:11 sss_rpcidmapd.5.xml:27 msgid "5" msgstr "5" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refmeta><refmiscinfo> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:12 sssd-ldap.5.xml:12 sssd-simple.5.xml:12 #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:12 sssd-ad.5.xml:12 sssd-sudo.5.xml:12 sssd-krb5.5.xml:12 #: sssd-ifp.5.xml:12 sss_rpcidmapd.5.xml:28 msgid "File Formats and Conventions" msgstr "Bestandsformaten en conventies" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refpurpose> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:17 msgid "the configuration file for SSSD" msgstr "het configuratiebestand voor SSSD" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><title> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:21 msgid "FILE FORMAT" msgstr "BESTANDSFORMAAT" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><programlisting> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:29 #, no-wrap msgid "" " <replaceable>[section]</replaceable>\n" " <replaceable>key</replaceable> = <replaceable>value</replaceable>\n" " <replaceable>key2</replaceable> = <replaceable>value2,value3</replaceable>\n" " " msgstr "" " <replaceable>[sectie]</replaceable>\n" " <replaceable>sleutel</replaceable> = <replaceable>waarde</replaceable>\n" " <replaceable>sleutel2</replaceable> = <replaceable>waarde2,waarde3</replaceable>\n" " " #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:24 msgid "" "The file has an ini-style syntax and consists of sections and parameters. A " "section begins with the name of the section in square brackets and continues " "until the next section begins. An example of section with single and multi-" "valued parameters: <placeholder type=\"programlisting\" id=\"0\"/>" msgstr "" "Het bestand heeft een ini-stijl syntaxis en bestaat uit secties en " "parameters. Een sectie begint met de naam van de sectie in rechte haken en " "gaat verder totdat de volgende sectie begint. Een voorbeeld van een sectie " "met een enkele en een meervoudige parameter: <placeholder type=" "\"programlisting\" id=\"0\"/>" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:36 msgid "" "The data types used are string (no quotes needed), integer and bool (with " "values of <quote>TRUE/FALSE</quote>)." msgstr "" "De datatypes gebruikt zijn tekst (geen quotes vereisd), numeriek en " "booleaans (met de waardes <quote>TRUE/FALSE</quote>)." #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:41 msgid "" "A line comment starts with a hash sign (<quote>#</quote>) or a semicolon " "(<quote>;</quote>). Inline comments are not supported." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:47 msgid "" "All sections can have an optional <replaceable>description</replaceable> " "parameter. Its function is only as a label for the section." msgstr "" "Alle secties kunnen een optionele <replaceable>description</replaceable> " "parameter bevatten. Dit fungeert slechts als label voor de sectie." #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:53 msgid "" "<filename>sssd.conf</filename> must be a regular file, owned by root and " "only root may read from or write to the file." msgstr "" "<filename>sssd.conf</filename> moet een standaardbestand zijn, de eigenaar " "moet root zijn en alleen root mag hem lezen en schrijven." #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><title> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:59 msgid "GENERAL OPTIONS" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:61 msgid "Following options are usable in more than one configuration sections." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><title> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:65 msgid "Options usable in all sections" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:69 msgid "debug_level (integer)" msgstr "debug_level (numeriek)" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:73 msgid "debug_timestamps (bool)" msgstr "debug_timestamps (bool)" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:76 msgid "Add a timestamp to the debug messages" msgstr "Voeg een tijdstempel toe aan de debugberichten" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:79 sssd.conf.5.xml:554 sssd.conf.5.xml:966 #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1597 sssd-ldap.5.xml:1694 sssd-ldap.5.xml:1756 #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2242 sssd-ldap.5.xml:2307 sssd-ldap.5.xml:2325 #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:375 sssd-ipa.5.xml:410 sssd-ad.5.xml:166 sssd-ad.5.xml:250 #: sssd-ad.5.xml:684 sssd-ad.5.xml:773 sssd-krb5.5.xml:490 msgid "Default: true" msgstr "Standaard: true" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:84 msgid "debug_microseconds (bool)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:87 msgid "Add microseconds to the timestamp in debug messages" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:90 sssd.conf.5.xml:920 sssd.conf.5.xml:1992 #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:678 sssd-ldap.5.xml:1471 sssd-ldap.5.xml:1490 #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1666 sssd-ldap.5.xml:2029 sssd-ipa.5.xml:139 #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:205 sssd-ipa.5.xml:522 sssd-krb5.5.xml:257 #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:291 sssd-krb5.5.xml:462 msgid "Default: false" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:67 sssd.conf.5.xml:101 sssd-ldap.5.xml:2050 msgid "<placeholder type=\"variablelist\" id=\"0\"/>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><title> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:99 msgid "Options usable in SERVICE and DOMAIN sections" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:103 msgid "timeout (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:106 msgid "" "Timeout in seconds between heartbeats for this service. This is used to " "ensure that the process is alive and capable of answering requests." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:111 sssd-ldap.5.xml:1342 msgid "Default: 10" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><title> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:121 msgid "SPECIAL SECTIONS" msgstr "SPECIALE SECTIES" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><title> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:124 msgid "The [sssd] section" msgstr "De [sssd] sectie" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><title> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:133 sssd.conf.5.xml:2076 msgid "Section parameters" msgstr "Sectie parameters" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:135 msgid "config_file_version (integer)" msgstr "config_file_version (numeriek)" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:138 msgid "" "Indicates what is the syntax of the config file. SSSD 0.6.0 and later use " "version 2." msgstr "" "Geeft aan welke syntaxis de configuratie gebruikt. SSSD 0.6.0 en hoger " "gebruiken versie 2." #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:144 msgid "services" msgstr "diensten" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:147 msgid "" "Comma separated list of services that are started when sssd itself starts." msgstr "" "Kommagescheiden lijst van diensten die gestart worden als sssd zelf start." #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:151 msgid "" "Supported services: nss, pam <phrase condition=\"with_sudo\">, sudo</phrase> " "<phrase condition=\"with_autofs\">, autofs</phrase> <phrase condition=" "\"with_ssh\">, ssh</phrase> <phrase condition=\"with_pac_responder\">, pac</" "phrase> <phrase condition=\"with_ifp\">, ifp</phrase>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:161 sssd.conf.5.xml:370 msgid "reconnection_retries (integer)" msgstr "reconnection_retries (numeriek)" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:164 sssd.conf.5.xml:373 msgid "" "Number of times services should attempt to reconnect in the event of a Data " "Provider crash or restart before they give up" msgstr "" "Aantal keer dat de service moet proberen om opnieuw te verbinden indien een " "Data Aanbieder crashed of opnieuw start voordat dit opgegeven wordt" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:169 sssd.conf.5.xml:378 msgid "Default: 3" msgstr "Standaard: 3" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:174 msgid "domains" msgstr "domeinen" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:177 msgid "" "A domain is a database containing user information. SSSD can use more " "domains at the same time, but at least one must be configured or SSSD won't " "start. This parameter described the list of domains in the order you want " "them to be queried. A domain name should only consist of alphanumeric ASCII " "characters, dashes and underscores." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:189 sssd.conf.5.xml:1778 msgid "re_expression (string)" msgstr "re_expression (tekst)" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:192 msgid "" "Default regular expression that describes how to parse the string containing " "user name and domain into these components." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:197 msgid "" "Each domain can have an individual regular expression configured. For some " "ID providers there are also default regular expressions. See DOMAIN " "SECTIONS for more info on these regular expressions." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:206 sssd.conf.5.xml:1829 msgid "full_name_format (string)" msgstr "full_name_format (tekst)" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:209 sssd.conf.5.xml:1832 msgid "" "A <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>printf</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>3</" "manvolnum> </citerefentry>-compatible format that describes how to compose a " "fully qualified name from user name and domain name components." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:220 sssd.conf.5.xml:1843 msgid "%1$s" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:221 sssd.conf.5.xml:1844 msgid "user name" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:224 sssd.conf.5.xml:1847 msgid "%2$s" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:227 sssd.conf.5.xml:1850 msgid "domain name as specified in the SSSD config file." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:233 sssd.conf.5.xml:1856 msgid "%3$s" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:236 sssd.conf.5.xml:1859 msgid "" "domain flat name. Mostly usable for Active Directory domains, both directly " "configured or discovered via IPA trusts." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:217 sssd.conf.5.xml:1840 msgid "" "The following expansions are supported: <placeholder type=\"variablelist\" " "id=\"0\"/>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:246 msgid "" "Each domain can have an individual format string configured. see DOMAIN " "SECTIONS for more info on this option." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:252 msgid "try_inotify (boolean)" msgstr "try_inotify (bool)" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:255 msgid "" "SSSD monitors the state of resolv.conf to identify when it needs to update " "its internal DNS resolver. By default, we will attempt to use inotify for " "this, and will fall back to polling resolv.conf every five seconds if " "inotify cannot be used." msgstr "" "SSSD houdt de stat van resolv.conf in de gaten om te zien wanneer de interne " "DNS-resolver bijgewerkt moet worden. Standaard wordt er geprobeerd om " "inotify te gebruiken en er wordt teruggevallen op iedere vijf seconden " "kijken of resolv.conf gewijzigd is als er geen inotify beschikbaar is." #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:263 msgid "" "There are some limited situations where it is preferred that we should skip " "even trying to use inotify. In these rare cases, this option should be set " "to 'false'" msgstr "" "Er zijn een aantal situaties waarin het de voorkeur heeft dat we het gebruik " "van inotify uitschakelen. In deze zeldzame gevallen kan de optie op 'false' " "gezet worden" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:269 msgid "" "Default: true on platforms where inotify is supported. False on other " "platforms." msgstr "" "Standaard: true op systemen waar inotify is ondersteund. False op andere " "systemen." #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:273 msgid "" "Note: this option will have no effect on platforms where inotify is " "unavailable. On these platforms, polling will always be used." msgstr "" "Merk op: deze optie heeft geen effect op systemen waar inotify niet " "beschikbaar is. Op deze systemen wordt altijd periodiek gekeken naar resolv." "conf." #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:280 msgid "krb5_rcache_dir (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:283 msgid "" "Directory on the filesystem where SSSD should store Kerberos replay cache " "files." msgstr "" "Map in het bestandssysteem waarin SSSD Kerberos replay cache bestanden moet " "opslaan." #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:287 msgid "" "This option accepts a special value __LIBKRB5_DEFAULTS__ that will instruct " "SSSD to let libkrb5 decide the appropriate location for the replay cache." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:293 msgid "" "Default: Distribution-specific and specified at build-time. " "(__LIBKRB5_DEFAULTS__ if not configured)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:300 msgid "default_domain_suffix (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:303 msgid "" "This string will be used as a default domain name for all names without a " "domain name component. The main use case is environments where the primary " "domain is intended for managing host policies and all users are located in a " "trusted domain. The option allows those users to log in just with their " "user name without giving a domain name as well." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:313 msgid "" "Please note that if this option is set all users from the primary domain " "have to use their fully qualified name, e.g. user@domain.name, to log in." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><refsect3><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:319 sssd-ldap.5.xml:649 sssd-ldap.5.xml:1430 #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1442 sssd-ldap.5.xml:1524 sssd-ad.5.xml:532 #: sssd-ad.5.xml:597 sssd-krb5.5.xml:401 include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:203 #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:214 msgid "Default: not set" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:324 #, fuzzy #| msgid "re_expression (string)" msgid "override_space (string)" msgstr "re_expression (tekst)" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:327 msgid "" "This parameter will replace spaces (space bar) with the given character for " "user and group names. e.g. (_). User name "john doe" will be " ""john_doe" This feature was added to help compatibility with shell " "scripts that have difficulty handling spaces, due to the default field " "separator in the shell." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:336 msgid "" "Please note it is a configuration error to use a replacement character that " "might be used in user or group names. If a name contains the replacement " "character SSSD tries to return the unmodified name but in general the result " "of a lookup is undefined." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:344 msgid "Default: not set (spaces will not be replaced)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:126 msgid "" "Individual pieces of SSSD functionality are provided by special SSSD " "services that are started and stopped together with SSSD. The services are " "managed by a special service frequently called <quote>monitor</quote>. The " "<quote>[sssd]</quote> section is used to configure the monitor as well as " "some other important options like the identity domains. <placeholder type=" "\"variablelist\" id=\"0\"/>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><title> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:355 msgid "SERVICES SECTIONS" msgstr "SERVICES SECTIE" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:357 msgid "" "Settings that can be used to configure different services are described in " "this section. They should reside in the [<replaceable>$NAME</replaceable>] " "section, for example, for NSS service, the section would be <quote>[nss]</" "quote>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><title> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:364 msgid "General service configuration options" msgstr "Algemene service configuratie-opties" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:366 msgid "These options can be used to configure any service." msgstr "Deze opties kunnen gebruikt worden om services te configureren." #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:383 msgid "fd_limit" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:386 msgid "" "This option specifies the maximum number of file descriptors that may be " "opened at one time by this SSSD process. On systems where SSSD is granted " "the CAP_SYS_RESOURCE capability, this will be an absolute setting. On " "systems without this capability, the resulting value will be the lower value " "of this or the limits.conf \"hard\" limit." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:395 msgid "Default: 8192 (or limits.conf \"hard\" limit)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:400 msgid "client_idle_timeout" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:403 msgid "" "This option specifies the number of seconds that a client of an SSSD process " "can hold onto a file descriptor without communicating on it. This value is " "limited in order to avoid resource exhaustion on the system." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:410 sssd.conf.5.xml:426 sssd.conf.5.xml:458 #: sssd.conf.5.xml:675 sssd.conf.5.xml:835 sssd.conf.5.xml:1161 #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1172 msgid "Default: 60" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:415 sssd.conf.5.xml:1150 msgid "force_timeout (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:418 sssd.conf.5.xml:1153 msgid "" "If a service is not responding to ping checks (see the <quote>timeout</" "quote> option), it is first sent the SIGTERM signal that instructs it to " "quit gracefully. If the service does not terminate after " "<quote>force_timeout</quote> seconds, the monitor will forcibly shut it down " "by sending a SIGKILL signal." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:431 msgid "offline_timeout (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:434 msgid "" "When SSSD switches to offline mode the amount of time before it tries to go " "back online will increase based upon the time spent disconnected. This " "value is in seconds and calculated by the following:" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:441 msgid "offline_timeout + random_offset" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:444 msgid "" "The random offset can increment up to 30 seconds. After each unsuccessful " "attempt to go online, the new interval is recalculated by the following:" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:449 msgid "new_interval = old_interval*2 + random_offset" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:452 msgid "" "Note that the maximum length of each interval is currently limited to one " "hour. If the calculated length of new_interval is greater than an hour, it " "will be forced to one hour." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><title> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:467 msgid "NSS configuration options" msgstr "NSS configuratie-opties" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:469 msgid "" "These options can be used to configure the Name Service Switch (NSS) service." msgstr "" "Deze opties kunnen worden gebruikt om de Name Serice Switch (NSS) service te " "configurere." #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:474 msgid "enum_cache_timeout (integer)" msgstr "enum_cache_timeout (numeriek)" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:477 msgid "" "How many seconds should nss_sss cache enumerations (requests for info about " "all users)" msgstr "" "Hoeveel seconden zouden nss_sss cache enumeraties (verzoeken om informatie " "over alle gebruikers)" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:481 msgid "Default: 120" msgstr "Standaard: 120" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:486 msgid "entry_cache_nowait_percentage (integer)" msgstr "entry_cache_nowait_percentage (numeriek)" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:489 msgid "" "The entry cache can be set to automatically update entries in the background " "if they are requested beyond a percentage of the entry_cache_timeout value " "for the domain." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:495 msgid "" "For example, if the domain's entry_cache_timeout is set to 30s and " "entry_cache_nowait_percentage is set to 50 (percent), entries that come in " "after 15 seconds past the last cache update will be returned immediately, " "but the SSSD will go and update the cache on its own, so that future " "requests will not need to block waiting for a cache update." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:505 msgid "" "Valid values for this option are 0-99 and represent a percentage of the " "entry_cache_timeout for each domain. For performance reasons, this " "percentage will never reduce the nowait timeout to less than 10 seconds. (0 " "disables this feature)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:513 msgid "Default: 50" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:518 msgid "entry_negative_timeout (integer)" msgstr "entry_negative_timeout (numeriek)" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:521 msgid "" "Specifies for how many seconds nss_sss should cache negative cache hits " "(that is, queries for invalid database entries, like nonexistent ones) " "before asking the back end again." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:527 sssd.conf.5.xml:944 msgid "Default: 15" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:532 msgid "filter_users, filter_groups (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:535 msgid "" "Exclude certain users from being fetched from the sss NSS database. This is " "particularly useful for system accounts. This option can also be set per-" "domain or include fully-qualified names to filter only users from the " "particular domain." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:542 msgid "Default: root" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:547 msgid "filter_users_in_groups (bool)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:550 msgid "" "If you want filtered user still be group members set this option to false." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:561 msgid "fallback_homedir (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:564 msgid "" "Set a default template for a user's home directory if one is not specified " "explicitly by the domain's data provider." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:569 msgid "" "The available values for this option are the same as for override_homedir." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><programlisting> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:575 #, no-wrap msgid "" "fallback_homedir = /home/%u\n" " " msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:573 include/override_homedir.xml:55 msgid "example: <placeholder type=\"programlisting\" id=\"0\"/>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:579 msgid "Default: not set (no substitution for unset home directories)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:585 msgid "override_shell (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:588 msgid "" "Override the login shell for all users. This option supersedes any other " "shell options if it takes effect and can be set either in the [nss] section " "or per-domain." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:594 msgid "Default: not set (SSSD will use the value retrieved from LDAP)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:600 msgid "allowed_shells (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:603 msgid "" "Restrict user shell to one of the listed values. The order of evaluation is:" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:606 msgid "1. If the shell is present in <quote>/etc/shells</quote>, it is used." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:610 msgid "" "2. If the shell is in the allowed_shells list but not in <quote>/etc/shells</" "quote>, use the value of the shell_fallback parameter." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:615 msgid "" "3. If the shell is not in the allowed_shells list and not in <quote>/etc/" "shells</quote>, a nologin shell is used." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:620 msgid "An empty string for shell is passed as-is to libc." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:623 msgid "" "The <quote>/etc/shells</quote> is only read on SSSD start up, which means " "that a restart of the SSSD is required in case a new shell is installed." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:627 msgid "Default: Not set. The user shell is automatically used." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:632 msgid "vetoed_shells (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:635 msgid "Replace any instance of these shells with the shell_fallback" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:640 msgid "shell_fallback (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:643 msgid "" "The default shell to use if an allowed shell is not installed on the machine." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:647 msgid "Default: /bin/sh" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:652 msgid "default_shell" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:655 msgid "" "The default shell to use if the provider does not return one during lookup. " "This option can be specified globally in the [nss] section or per-domain." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:661 msgid "" "Default: not set (Return NULL if no shell is specified and rely on libc to " "substitute something sensible when necessary, usually /bin/sh)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:668 sssd.conf.5.xml:828 msgid "get_domains_timeout (int)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:671 sssd.conf.5.xml:831 msgid "" "Specifies time in seconds for which the list of subdomains will be " "considered valid." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:680 msgid "memcache_timeout (int)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:683 msgid "" "Specifies time in seconds for which records in the in-memory cache will be " "valid" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:687 sssd-ldap.5.xml:692 msgid "Default: 300" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><title> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:694 msgid "PAM configuration options" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:696 msgid "" "These options can be used to configure the Pluggable Authentication Module " "(PAM) service." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:701 msgid "offline_credentials_expiration (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:704 msgid "" "If the authentication provider is offline, how long should we allow cached " "logins (in days since the last successful online login)." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:709 sssd.conf.5.xml:722 msgid "Default: 0 (No limit)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:715 msgid "offline_failed_login_attempts (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:718 msgid "" "If the authentication provider is offline, how many failed login attempts " "are allowed." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:728 msgid "offline_failed_login_delay (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:731 msgid "" "The time in minutes which has to pass after offline_failed_login_attempts " "has been reached before a new login attempt is possible." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:736 msgid "" "If set to 0 the user cannot authenticate offline if " "offline_failed_login_attempts has been reached. Only a successful online " "authentication can enable offline authentication again." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:742 sssd.conf.5.xml:795 msgid "Default: 5" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:748 msgid "pam_verbosity (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:751 msgid "" "Controls what kind of messages are shown to the user during authentication. " "The higher the number to more messages are displayed." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:756 msgid "Currently sssd supports the following values:" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:759 msgid "<emphasis>0</emphasis>: do not show any message" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:762 msgid "<emphasis>1</emphasis>: show only important messages" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:766 msgid "<emphasis>2</emphasis>: show informational messages" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:769 msgid "<emphasis>3</emphasis>: show all messages and debug information" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:773 sssd.8.xml:63 msgid "Default: 1" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:778 msgid "pam_id_timeout (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:781 msgid "" "For any PAM request while SSSD is online, the SSSD will attempt to " "immediately update the cached identity information for the user in order to " "ensure that authentication takes place with the latest information." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:787 msgid "" "A complete PAM conversation may perform multiple PAM requests, such as " "account management and session opening. This option controls (on a per-" "client-application basis) how long (in seconds) we can cache the identity " "information to avoid excessive round-trips to the identity provider." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:801 msgid "pam_pwd_expiration_warning (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:804 sssd.conf.5.xml:1342 msgid "Display a warning N days before the password expires." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:807 msgid "" "Please note that the backend server has to provide information about the " "expiration time of the password. If this information is missing, sssd " "cannot display a warning." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:813 sssd.conf.5.xml:1345 msgid "" "If zero is set, then this filter is not applied, i.e. if the expiration " "warning was received from backend server, it will automatically be displayed." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:818 msgid "" "This setting can be overridden by setting <emphasis>pwd_expiration_warning</" "emphasis> for a particular domain." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:823 sssd.8.xml:79 msgid "Default: 0" msgstr "Standaard: 0" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:840 #, fuzzy #| msgid "re_expression (string)" msgid "pam_trusted_users (string)" msgstr "re_expression (tekst)" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:843 msgid "" "Specifies the comma-separated list of UID values or user names that are " "allowed to access the PAM responder. User names are resolved to UIDs at " "startup." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:849 msgid "Default: all (All users are allowed to access the PAM responder)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:853 msgid "" "Please note that UID 0 is always allowed to access the PAM responder even in " "case it is not in the pam_trusted_users list." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:858 msgid "" "Also please note that if there is a user name in pam_trusted_users list " "which fails to be resolved it will cause that SSSD will not be started." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:865 msgid "pam_public_domains (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:868 msgid "" "Specifies the comma-separated list of domain names that are accessible even " "to untrusted users." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:872 msgid "Two special values for pam_public_domains option are defined:" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:876 msgid "" "all (Untrusted users are allowed to access all domains in PAM responder.)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:880 msgid "" "none (Untrusted users are not allowed to access any domains PAM in " "responder.)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:884 sssd.conf.5.xml:1144 sssd-ldap.5.xml:1725 msgid "Default: none" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><title> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:893 msgid "SUDO configuration options" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:895 msgid "" "These options can be used to configure the sudo service. The detailed " "instructions for configuration of <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sudo</" "refentrytitle> <manvolnum>8</manvolnum> </citerefentry> to work with " "<citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sssd</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>8</manvolnum> " "</citerefentry> are in the manual page <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sssd-" "sudo</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </citerefentry>." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:912 msgid "sudo_timed (bool)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:915 msgid "" "Whether or not to evaluate the sudoNotBefore and sudoNotAfter attributes " "that implement time-dependent sudoers entries." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><title> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:928 msgid "AUTOFS configuration options" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:930 msgid "These options can be used to configure the autofs service." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:934 msgid "autofs_negative_timeout (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:937 msgid "" "Specifies for how many seconds should the autofs responder negative cache " "hits (that is, queries for invalid map entries, like nonexistent ones) " "before asking the back end again." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><title> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:953 msgid "SSH configuration options" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:955 msgid "These options can be used to configure the SSH service." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:959 msgid "ssh_hash_known_hosts (bool)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:962 msgid "" "Whether or not to hash host names and addresses in the managed known_hosts " "file." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:971 msgid "ssh_known_hosts_timeout (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:974 msgid "" "How many seconds to keep a host in the managed known_hosts file after its " "host keys were requested." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:978 msgid "Default: 180" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><title> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:986 msgid "PAC responder configuration options" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:988 msgid "" "The PAC responder works together with the authorization data plugin for MIT " "Kerberos sssd_pac_plugin.so and a sub-domain provider. The plugin sends the " "PAC data during a GSSAPI authentication to the PAC responder. The sub-domain " "provider collects domain SID and ID ranges of the domain the client is " "joined to and of remote trusted domains from the local domain controller. " "If the PAC is decoded and evaluated some of the following operations are " "done:" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:997 msgid "" "If the remote user does not exist in the cache, it is created. The uid is " "determined with the help of the SID, trusted domains will have UPGs and the " "gid will have the same value as the uid. The home directory is set based on " "the subdomain_homedir parameter. The shell will be empty by default, i.e. " "the system defaults are used, but can be overwritten with the default_shell " "parameter." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1005 msgid "" "If there are SIDs of groups from domains sssd knows about, the user will be " "added to those groups." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1011 msgid "These options can be used to configure the PAC responder." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1015 sssd-ifp.5.xml:50 msgid "allowed_uids (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1018 msgid "" "Specifies the comma-separated list of UID values or user names that are " "allowed to access the PAC responder. User names are resolved to UIDs at " "startup." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1024 msgid "Default: 0 (only the root user is allowed to access the PAC responder)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1028 msgid "" "Please note that although the UID 0 is used as the default it will be " "overwritten with this option. If you still want to allow the root user to " "access the PAC responder, which would be the typical case, you have to add 0 " "to the list of allowed UIDs as well." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><title> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1042 msgid "DOMAIN SECTIONS" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1049 msgid "min_id,max_id (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1052 msgid "" "UID and GID limits for the domain. If a domain contains an entry that is " "outside these limits, it is ignored." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1057 msgid "" "For users, this affects the primary GID limit. The user will not be returned " "to NSS if either the UID or the primary GID is outside the range. For non-" "primary group memberships, those that are in range will be reported as " "expected." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1064 msgid "" "These ID limits affect even saving entries to cache, not only returning them " "by name or ID." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1068 msgid "Default: 1 for min_id, 0 (no limit) for max_id" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1074 msgid "enumerate (bool)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1077 msgid "" "Determines if a domain can be enumerated. This parameter can have one of the " "following values:" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1081 msgid "TRUE = Users and groups are enumerated" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1084 msgid "FALSE = No enumerations for this domain" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1087 sssd.conf.5.xml:1319 sssd.conf.5.xml:1428 #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1445 msgid "Default: FALSE" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1090 msgid "" "Note: Enabling enumeration has a moderate performance impact on SSSD while " "enumeration is running. It may take up to several minutes after SSSD startup " "to fully complete enumerations. During this time, individual requests for " "information will go directly to LDAP, though it may be slow, due to the " "heavy enumeration processing. Saving a large number of entries to cache " "after the enumeration completes might also be CPU intensive as the " "memberships have to be recomputed." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1103 msgid "" "While the first enumeration is running, requests for the complete user or " "group lists may return no results until it completes." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1108 msgid "" "Further, enabling enumeration may increase the time necessary to detect " "network disconnection, as longer timeouts are required to ensure that " "enumeration lookups are completed successfully. For more information, refer " "to the man pages for the specific id_provider in use." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1116 msgid "" "For the reasons cited above, enabling enumeration is not recommended, " "especially in large environments." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1124 msgid "subdomain_enumerate (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1131 msgid "all" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1132 msgid "All discovered trusted domains will be enumerated" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1135 msgid "none" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1136 msgid "No discovered trusted domains will be enumerated" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1127 msgid "" "Whether any of autodetected trusted domains should be enumerated. The " "supported values are: <placeholder type=\"variablelist\" id=\"0\"/> " "Optionally, a list of one or more domain names can enable enumeration just " "for these trusted domains." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1167 msgid "entry_cache_timeout (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1170 msgid "" "How many seconds should nss_sss consider entries valid before asking the " "backend again" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1174 msgid "" "The cache expiration timestamps are stored as attributes of individual " "objects in the cache. Therefore, changing the cache timeout only has effect " "for newly added or expired entries. You should run the <citerefentry> " "<refentrytitle>sss_cache</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>8</manvolnum> </" "citerefentry> tool in order to force refresh of entries that have already " "been cached." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1187 msgid "Default: 5400" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1193 msgid "entry_cache_user_timeout (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1196 msgid "" "How many seconds should nss_sss consider user entries valid before asking " "the backend again" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1200 sssd.conf.5.xml:1213 sssd.conf.5.xml:1226 #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1239 sssd.conf.5.xml:1252 sssd.conf.5.xml:1266 #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1280 msgid "Default: entry_cache_timeout" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1206 msgid "entry_cache_group_timeout (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1209 msgid "" "How many seconds should nss_sss consider group entries valid before asking " "the backend again" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1219 msgid "entry_cache_netgroup_timeout (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1222 msgid "" "How many seconds should nss_sss consider netgroup entries valid before " "asking the backend again" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1232 msgid "entry_cache_service_timeout (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1235 msgid "" "How many seconds should nss_sss consider service entries valid before asking " "the backend again" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1245 msgid "entry_cache_sudo_timeout (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1248 msgid "" "How many seconds should sudo consider rules valid before asking the backend " "again" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1258 msgid "entry_cache_autofs_timeout (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1261 msgid "" "How many seconds should the autofs service consider automounter maps valid " "before asking the backend again" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1272 #, fuzzy #| msgid "enum_cache_timeout (integer)" msgid "entry_cache_ssh_host_timeout (integer)" msgstr "enum_cache_timeout (numeriek)" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1275 msgid "" "How many seconds to keep a host ssh key after refresh. IE how long to cache " "the host key for." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1286 msgid "refresh_expired_interval (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1289 msgid "" "Specifies how many seconds SSSD has to wait before triggering a background " "refresh task which will refresh all expired or nearly expired records." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1294 msgid "Currently only refreshing expired netgroups is supported." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1298 msgid "You can consider setting this value to 3/4 * entry_cache_timeout." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1302 sssd-ipa.5.xml:221 msgid "Default: 0 (disabled)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1308 msgid "cache_credentials (bool)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1311 msgid "Determines if user credentials are also cached in the local LDB cache" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1315 msgid "User credentials are stored in a SHA512 hash, not in plaintext" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1324 msgid "account_cache_expiration (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1327 msgid "" "Number of days entries are left in cache after last successful login before " "being removed during a cleanup of the cache. 0 means keep forever. The " "value of this parameter must be greater than or equal to " "offline_credentials_expiration." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1334 msgid "Default: 0 (unlimited)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1339 msgid "pwd_expiration_warning (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1350 msgid "" "Please note that the backend server has to provide information about the " "expiration time of the password. If this information is missing, sssd " "cannot display a warning. Also an auth provider has to be configured for the " "backend." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1357 msgid "Default: 7 (Kerberos), 0 (LDAP)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1363 msgid "id_provider (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1366 msgid "" "The identification provider used for the domain. Supported ID providers are:" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1370 msgid "<quote>proxy</quote>: Support a legacy NSS provider" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1373 sssd.conf.5.xml:1491 msgid "<quote>local</quote>: SSSD internal provider for local users" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1377 msgid "" "<quote>ldap</quote>: LDAP provider. See <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sssd-" "ldap</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </citerefentry> for more " "information on configuring LDAP." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1385 sssd.conf.5.xml:1471 sssd.conf.5.xml:1526 #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1579 msgid "" "<quote>ipa</quote>: FreeIPA and Red Hat Enterprise Identity Management " "provider. See <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sssd-ipa</refentrytitle> " "<manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </citerefentry> for more information on configuring " "FreeIPA." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1394 sssd.conf.5.xml:1480 sssd.conf.5.xml:1535 #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1588 msgid "" "<quote>ad</quote>: Active Directory provider. See <citerefentry> " "<refentrytitle>sssd-ad</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </" "citerefentry> for more information on configuring Active Directory." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1405 msgid "use_fully_qualified_names (bool)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1408 msgid "" "Use the full name and domain (as formatted by the domain's full_name_format) " "as the user's login name reported to NSS." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1413 msgid "" "If set to TRUE, all requests to this domain must use fully qualified names. " "For example, if used in LOCAL domain that contains a \"test\" user, " "<command>getent passwd test</command> wouldn't find the user while " "<command>getent passwd test@LOCAL</command> would." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1421 msgid "" "NOTE: This option has no effect on netgroup lookups due to their tendency to " "include nested netgroups without qualified names. For netgroups, all domains " "will be searched when an unqualified name is requested." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1433 msgid "ignore_group_members (bool)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1436 msgid "Do not return group members for group lookups." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1439 msgid "" "If set to TRUE, the group membership attribute is not requested from the " "ldap server, and group members are not returned when processing group lookup " "calls." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1450 msgid "auth_provider (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1453 msgid "" "The authentication provider used for the domain. Supported auth providers " "are:" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1457 sssd.conf.5.xml:1519 msgid "" "<quote>ldap</quote> for native LDAP authentication. See <citerefentry> " "<refentrytitle>sssd-ldap</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </" "citerefentry> for more information on configuring LDAP." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1464 msgid "" "<quote>krb5</quote> for Kerberos authentication. See <citerefentry> " "<refentrytitle>sssd-krb5</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </" "citerefentry> for more information on configuring Kerberos." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1488 msgid "" "<quote>proxy</quote> for relaying authentication to some other PAM target." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1495 msgid "<quote>none</quote> disables authentication explicitly." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1498 msgid "" "Default: <quote>id_provider</quote> is used if it is set and can handle " "authentication requests." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1504 msgid "access_provider (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1507 msgid "" "The access control provider used for the domain. There are two built-in " "access providers (in addition to any included in installed backends) " "Internal special providers are:" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1513 msgid "" "<quote>permit</quote> always allow access. It's the only permitted access " "provider for a local domain." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1516 msgid "<quote>deny</quote> always deny access." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1543 msgid "" "<quote>simple</quote> access control based on access or deny lists. See " "<citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sssd-simple</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</" "manvolnum></citerefentry> for more information on configuring the simple " "access module." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1550 msgid "Default: <quote>permit</quote>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1555 msgid "chpass_provider (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1558 msgid "" "The provider which should handle change password operations for the domain. " "Supported change password providers are:" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1563 msgid "" "<quote>ldap</quote> to change a password stored in a LDAP server. See " "<citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sssd-ldap</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</" "manvolnum> </citerefentry> for more information on configuring LDAP." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1571 msgid "" "<quote>krb5</quote> to change the Kerberos password. See <citerefentry> " "<refentrytitle>sssd-krb5</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </" "citerefentry> for more information on configuring Kerberos." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1596 msgid "" "<quote>proxy</quote> for relaying password changes to some other PAM target." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1600 msgid "<quote>none</quote> disallows password changes explicitly." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1603 msgid "" "Default: <quote>auth_provider</quote> is used if it is set and can handle " "change password requests." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1610 msgid "sudo_provider (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1613 msgid "The SUDO provider used for the domain. Supported SUDO providers are:" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1617 msgid "" "<quote>ldap</quote> for rules stored in LDAP. See <citerefentry> " "<refentrytitle>sssd-ldap</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </" "citerefentry> for more information on configuring LDAP." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1625 msgid "" "<quote>ipa</quote> the same as <quote>ldap</quote> but with IPA default " "settings." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1629 msgid "" "<quote>ad</quote> the same as <quote>ldap</quote> but with AD default " "settings." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1633 msgid "<quote>none</quote> disables SUDO explicitly." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1636 sssd.conf.5.xml:1714 sssd.conf.5.xml:1746 #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1771 msgid "Default: The value of <quote>id_provider</quote> is used if it is set." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1640 msgid "" "The detailed instructions for configuration of sudo_provider are in the " "manual page <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sssd-sudo</refentrytitle> " "<manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </citerefentry>. There are many configuration " "options that can be used to adjust the behavior. Please refer to " "\"ldap_sudo_*\" in <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sssd-ldap</refentrytitle> " "<manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </citerefentry>." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1657 msgid "selinux_provider (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1660 msgid "" "The provider which should handle loading of selinux settings. Note that this " "provider will be called right after access provider ends. Supported selinux " "providers are:" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1666 msgid "" "<quote>ipa</quote> to load selinux settings from an IPA server. See " "<citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sssd-ipa</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</" "manvolnum> </citerefentry> for more information on configuring IPA." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1674 msgid "<quote>none</quote> disallows fetching selinux settings explicitly." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1677 msgid "" "Default: <quote>id_provider</quote> is used if it is set and can handle " "selinux loading requests." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1683 msgid "subdomains_provider (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1686 msgid "" "The provider which should handle fetching of subdomains. This value should " "be always the same as id_provider. Supported subdomain providers are:" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1692 msgid "" "<quote>ipa</quote> to load a list of subdomains from an IPA server. See " "<citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sssd-ipa</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</" "manvolnum> </citerefentry> for more information on configuring IPA." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1701 msgid "" "<quote>ad</quote> to load a list of subdomains from an Active Directory " "server. See <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sssd-ad</refentrytitle> " "<manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </citerefentry> for more information on configuring " "the AD provider." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1710 msgid "<quote>none</quote> disallows fetching subdomains explicitly." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1721 msgid "autofs_provider (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1724 msgid "" "The autofs provider used for the domain. Supported autofs providers are:" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1728 msgid "" "<quote>ldap</quote> to load maps stored in LDAP. See <citerefentry> " "<refentrytitle>sssd-ldap</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </" "citerefentry> for more information on configuring LDAP." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1735 msgid "" "<quote>ipa</quote> to load maps stored in an IPA server. See <citerefentry> " "<refentrytitle>sssd-ipa</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </" "citerefentry> for more information on configuring IPA." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1743 msgid "<quote>none</quote> disables autofs explicitly." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1753 msgid "hostid_provider (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1756 msgid "" "The provider used for retrieving host identity information. Supported " "hostid providers are:" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1760 msgid "" "<quote>ipa</quote> to load host identity stored in an IPA server. See " "<citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sssd-ipa</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</" "manvolnum> </citerefentry> for more information on configuring IPA." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1768 msgid "<quote>none</quote> disables hostid explicitly." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1781 msgid "" "Regular expression for this domain that describes how to parse the string " "containing user name and domain into these components. The \"domain\" can " "match either the SSSD configuration domain name, or, in the case of IPA " "trust subdomains and Active Directory domains, the flat (NetBIOS) name of " "the domain." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1790 msgid "" "Default for the AD and IPA provider: <quote>(((?P<domain>[^\\\\]+)\\" "\\(?P<name>.+$))|((?P<name>[^@]+)@(?P<domain>.+$))|(^(?" "P<name>[^@\\\\]+)$))</quote> which allows three different styles for " "user names:" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1795 msgid "username" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1798 msgid "username@domain.name" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1801 msgid "domain\\username" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1804 msgid "" "While the first two correspond to the general default the third one is " "introduced to allow easy integration of users from Windows domains." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1809 msgid "" "Default: <quote>(?P<name>[^@]+)@?(?P<domain>[^@]*$)</quote> " "which translates to \"the name is everything up to the <quote>@</quote> " "sign, the domain everything after that\"" msgstr "" "Standaard: <quote>(?P<name>[^@]+)@?(?P<domain>[^@]*$)</quote> " "wat zich vertaalt tot \"de gebruikersnaam is alles tot <quote>@</quote> , " "het domein alles daarna\"" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1815 msgid "" "PLEASE NOTE: the support for non-unique named subpatterns is not available " "on all platforms (e.g. RHEL5 and SLES10). Only platforms with libpcre " "version 7 or higher can support non-unique named subpatterns." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1822 msgid "" "PLEASE NOTE ALSO: older version of libpcre only support the Python syntax (?" "P<name>) to label subpatterns." msgstr "" "MER OOK OP: oudere versies van libpcre ondersteunen alleen de Pyton syntaxis " "(?P<name>) om subpatronen aan te geven." #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1869 msgid "Default: <quote>%1$s@%2$s</quote>." msgstr "Standaard: <quote>%1$s@%2$s</quote>." #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1875 msgid "lookup_family_order (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1878 msgid "" "Provides the ability to select preferred address family to use when " "performing DNS lookups." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1882 msgid "Supported values:" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1885 msgid "ipv4_first: Try looking up IPv4 address, if that fails, try IPv6" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1888 msgid "ipv4_only: Only attempt to resolve hostnames to IPv4 addresses." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1891 msgid "ipv6_first: Try looking up IPv6 address, if that fails, try IPv4" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1894 msgid "ipv6_only: Only attempt to resolve hostnames to IPv6 addresses." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1897 msgid "Default: ipv4_first" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1903 msgid "dns_resolver_timeout (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1906 msgid "" "Defines the amount of time (in seconds) to wait for a reply from the DNS " "resolver before assuming that it is unreachable. If this timeout is reached, " "the domain will continue to operate in offline mode." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1912 sssd-ldap.5.xml:1156 sssd-ldap.5.xml:1198 #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1213 sssd-krb5.5.xml:239 msgid "Default: 6" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1918 msgid "dns_discovery_domain (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1921 msgid "" "If service discovery is used in the back end, specifies the domain part of " "the service discovery DNS query." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1925 msgid "Default: Use the domain part of machine's hostname" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1931 msgid "override_gid (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1934 msgid "Override the primary GID value with the one specified." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1940 #, fuzzy #| msgid "re_expression (string)" msgid "case_sensitive (string)" msgstr "re_expression (tekst)" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1948 msgid "True" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1951 msgid "Case sensitive. This value is invalid for AD provider." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1957 msgid "False" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1959 msgid "Case insensitive." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1963 msgid "Preserving" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1966 msgid "" "Same as False (case insensitive), but does not lowercase names in the output " "of getpwnam and getgrnam." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1943 msgid "" "Treat user and group names as case sensitive. At the moment, this option is " "not supported in the local provider. Possible option values are: " "<placeholder type=\"variablelist\" id=\"0\"/>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1975 msgid "Default: True (False for AD provider)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1981 msgid "proxy_fast_alias (boolean)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1984 msgid "" "When a user or group is looked up by name in the proxy provider, a second " "lookup by ID is performed to \"canonicalize\" the name in case the requested " "name was an alias. Setting this option to true would cause the SSSD to " "perform the ID lookup from cache for performance reasons." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1998 msgid "subdomain_homedir (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:2009 msgid "%F" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:2010 msgid "flat (NetBIOS) name of a subdomain." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:2001 msgid "" "Use this homedir as default value for all subdomains within this domain in " "IPA AD trust. See <emphasis>override_homedir</emphasis> for info about " "possible values. In addition to those, the expansion below can only be used " "with <emphasis>subdomain_homedir</emphasis>. <placeholder type=" "\"variablelist\" id=\"0\"/>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:2015 msgid "" "The value can be overridden by <emphasis>override_homedir</emphasis> option." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:2019 msgid "Default: <filename>/home/%d/%u</filename>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:2024 msgid "realmd_tags (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:2027 msgid "" "Various tags stored by the realmd configuration service for this domain." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:1044 msgid "" "These configuration options can be present in a domain configuration " "section, that is, in a section called <quote>[domain/<replaceable>NAME</" "replaceable>]</quote> <placeholder type=\"variablelist\" id=\"0\"/>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:2040 msgid "proxy_pam_target (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:2043 msgid "The proxy target PAM proxies to." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:2046 msgid "" "Default: not set by default, you have to take an existing pam configuration " "or create a new one and add the service name here." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:2054 msgid "proxy_lib_name (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:2057 msgid "" "The name of the NSS library to use in proxy domains. The NSS functions " "searched for in the library are in the form of _nss_$(libName)_$(function), " "for example _nss_files_getpwent." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:2036 msgid "" "Options valid for proxy domains. <placeholder type=\"variablelist\" id=" "\"0\"/>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><title> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:2069 msgid "The local domain section" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:2071 msgid "" "This section contains settings for domain that stores users and groups in " "SSSD native database, that is, a domain that uses " "<replaceable>id_provider=local</replaceable>." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:2078 msgid "default_shell (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:2081 msgid "The default shell for users created with SSSD userspace tools." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:2085 msgid "Default: <filename>/bin/bash</filename>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:2090 msgid "base_directory (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:2093 msgid "" "The tools append the login name to <replaceable>base_directory</replaceable> " "and use that as the home directory." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:2098 msgid "Default: <filename>/home</filename>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:2103 msgid "create_homedir (bool)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:2106 msgid "" "Indicate if a home directory should be created by default for new users. " "Can be overridden on command line." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:2110 sssd.conf.5.xml:2122 msgid "Default: TRUE" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:2115 msgid "remove_homedir (bool)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:2118 msgid "" "Indicate if a home directory should be removed by default for deleted " "users. Can be overridden on command line." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:2127 msgid "homedir_umask (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:2130 msgid "" "Used by <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sss_useradd</refentrytitle> " "<manvolnum>8</manvolnum> </citerefentry> to specify the default permissions " "on a newly created home directory." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:2138 msgid "Default: 077" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:2143 msgid "skel_dir (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:2146 msgid "" "The skeleton directory, which contains files and directories to be copied in " "the user's home directory, when the home directory is created by " "<citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sss_useradd</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>8</" "manvolnum> </citerefentry>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:2156 msgid "Default: <filename>/etc/skel</filename>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:2161 msgid "mail_dir (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:2164 msgid "" "The mail spool directory. This is needed to manipulate the mailbox when its " "corresponding user account is modified or deleted. If not specified, a " "default value is used." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:2171 msgid "Default: <filename>/var/mail</filename>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:2176 msgid "userdel_cmd (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:2179 msgid "" "The command that is run after a user is removed. The command us passed the " "username of the user being removed as the first and only parameter. The " "return code of the command is not taken into account." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:2185 msgid "Default: None, no command is run" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><title> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:2195 sssd-ldap.5.xml:2476 sssd-simple.5.xml:131 #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:694 sssd-ad.5.xml:792 sssd-krb5.5.xml:519 #: sss_rpcidmapd.5.xml:98 msgid "EXAMPLE" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><programlisting> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:2201 #, no-wrap msgid "" "[sssd]\n" "domains = LDAP\n" "services = nss, pam\n" "config_file_version = 2\n" "\n" "[nss]\n" "filter_groups = root\n" "filter_users = root\n" "\n" "[pam]\n" "\n" "[domain/LDAP]\n" "id_provider = ldap\n" "ldap_uri = ldap://ldap.example.com\n" "ldap_search_base = dc=example,dc=com\n" "\n" "auth_provider = krb5\n" "krb5_server = kerberos.example.com\n" "krb5_realm = EXAMPLE.COM\n" "cache_credentials = true\n" "\n" "min_id = 10000\n" "max_id = 20000\n" "enumerate = False\n" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd.conf.5.xml:2197 msgid "" "The following example shows a typical SSSD config. It does not describe " "configuration of the domains themselves - refer to documentation on " "configuring domains for more details. <placeholder type=\"programlisting\" " "id=\"0\"/>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refname> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:10 sssd-ldap.5.xml:16 msgid "sssd-ldap" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refpurpose> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:17 msgid "SSSD LDAP provider" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:23 msgid "" "This manual page describes the configuration of LDAP domains for " "<citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sssd</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>8</manvolnum> " "</citerefentry>. Refer to the <quote>FILE FORMAT</quote> section of the " "<citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sssd.conf</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</" "manvolnum> </citerefentry> manual page for detailed syntax information." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:35 msgid "You can configure SSSD to use more than one LDAP domain." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:38 msgid "" "LDAP back end supports id, auth, access and chpass providers. If you want to " "authenticate against an LDAP server either TLS/SSL or LDAPS is required. " "<command>sssd</command> <emphasis>does not</emphasis> support authentication " "over an unencrypted channel. If the LDAP server is used only as an identity " "provider, an encrypted channel is not needed. Please refer to " "<quote>ldap_access_filter</quote> config option for more information about " "using LDAP as an access provider." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><title> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:49 sssd-simple.5.xml:69 sssd-ipa.5.xml:70 sssd-ad.5.xml:88 #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:63 sssd-ifp.5.xml:44 msgid "CONFIGURATION OPTIONS" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:60 msgid "ldap_uri, ldap_backup_uri (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:63 msgid "" "Specifies the comma-separated list of URIs of the LDAP servers to which SSSD " "should connect in the order of preference. Refer to the <quote>FAILOVER</" "quote> section for more information on failover and server redundancy. If " "neither option is specified, service discovery is enabled. For more " "information, refer to the <quote>SERVICE DISCOVERY</quote> section." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:70 msgid "The format of the URI must match the format defined in RFC 2732:" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:73 msgid "ldap[s]://<host>[:port]" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:76 msgid "" "For explicit IPv6 addresses, <host> must be enclosed in brackets []" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:79 msgid "example: ldap://[fc00::126:25]:389" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:85 msgid "ldap_chpass_uri, ldap_chpass_backup_uri (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:88 msgid "" "Specifies the comma-separated list of URIs of the LDAP servers to which SSSD " "should connect in the order of preference to change the password of a user. " "Refer to the <quote>FAILOVER</quote> section for more information on " "failover and server redundancy." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:95 msgid "To enable service discovery ldap_chpass_dns_service_name must be set." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:99 msgid "Default: empty, i.e. ldap_uri is used." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:105 msgid "ldap_search_base (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:108 msgid "The default base DN to use for performing LDAP user operations." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:112 msgid "" "Starting with SSSD 1.7.0, SSSD supports multiple search bases using the " "syntax:" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:116 msgid "search_base[?scope?[filter][?search_base?scope?[filter]]*]" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:119 msgid "The scope can be one of \"base\", \"onelevel\" or \"subtree\"." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:122 include/ldap_search_bases.xml:18 msgid "" "The filter must be a valid LDAP search filter as specified by http://www." "ietf.org/rfc/rfc2254.txt" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:126 sssd-ldap.5.xml:632 sssd-ad.5.xml:212 msgid "Examples:" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:129 msgid "" "ldap_search_base = dc=example,dc=com (which is equivalent to) " "ldap_search_base = dc=example,dc=com?subtree?" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:134 msgid "" "ldap_search_base = cn=host_specific,dc=example,dc=com?subtree?" "(host=thishost)?dc=example.com?subtree?" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:137 msgid "" "Note: It is unsupported to have multiple search bases which reference " "identically-named objects (for example, groups with the same name in two " "different search bases). This will lead to unpredictable behavior on client " "machines." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:144 msgid "" "Default: If not set, the value of the defaultNamingContext or namingContexts " "attribute from the RootDSE of the LDAP server is used. If " "defaultNamingContext does not exist or has an empty value namingContexts is " "used. The namingContexts attribute must have a single value with the DN of " "the search base of the LDAP server to make this work. Multiple values are " "are not supported." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:158 msgid "ldap_schema (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:161 msgid "" "Specifies the Schema Type in use on the target LDAP server. Depending on " "the selected schema, the default attribute names retrieved from the servers " "may vary. The way that some attributes are handled may also differ." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:168 msgid "Four schema types are currently supported:" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:172 msgid "rfc2307" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:177 msgid "rfc2307bis" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:182 msgid "IPA" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:187 msgid "AD" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:193 msgid "" "The main difference between these schema types is how group memberships are " "recorded in the server. With rfc2307, group members are listed by name in " "the <emphasis>memberUid</emphasis> attribute. With rfc2307bis and IPA, " "group members are listed by DN and stored in the <emphasis>member</emphasis> " "attribute. The AD schema type sets the attributes to correspond with Active " "Directory 2008r2 values." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:203 msgid "Default: rfc2307" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:209 msgid "ldap_default_bind_dn (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:212 msgid "The default bind DN to use for performing LDAP operations." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:219 msgid "ldap_default_authtok_type (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:222 msgid "The type of the authentication token of the default bind DN." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:226 msgid "The two mechanisms currently supported are:" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:229 msgid "password" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:232 msgid "obfuscated_password" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:235 msgid "Default: password" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:241 msgid "ldap_default_authtok (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:244 msgid "" "The authentication token of the default bind DN. Only clear text passwords " "are currently supported." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:251 msgid "ldap_user_object_class (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:254 msgid "The object class of a user entry in LDAP." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:257 msgid "Default: posixAccount" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:263 msgid "ldap_user_name (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:266 msgid "The LDAP attribute that corresponds to the user's login name." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:270 msgid "Default: uid" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:276 msgid "ldap_user_uid_number (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:279 msgid "The LDAP attribute that corresponds to the user's id." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:283 msgid "Default: uidNumber" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:289 msgid "ldap_user_gid_number (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:292 msgid "The LDAP attribute that corresponds to the user's primary group id." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:296 sssd-ldap.5.xml:830 msgid "Default: gidNumber" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:302 msgid "ldap_user_gecos (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:305 msgid "The LDAP attribute that corresponds to the user's gecos field." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:309 msgid "Default: gecos" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:315 msgid "ldap_user_home_directory (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:318 msgid "The LDAP attribute that contains the name of the user's home directory." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:322 msgid "Default: homeDirectory" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:328 msgid "ldap_user_shell (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:331 msgid "The LDAP attribute that contains the path to the user's default shell." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:335 msgid "Default: loginShell" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:341 msgid "ldap_user_objectsid (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:344 msgid "" "The LDAP attribute that contains the objectSID of an LDAP user object. This " "is usually only necessary for ActiveDirectory servers." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:349 sssd-ldap.5.xml:857 msgid "Default: ipaNTSecurityIdentifier for IPA, objectSID for other servers." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:356 msgid "ldap_user_modify_timestamp (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:359 sssd-ldap.5.xml:867 sssd-ldap.5.xml:1072 msgid "" "The LDAP attribute that contains timestamp of the last modification of the " "parent object." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:363 sssd-ldap.5.xml:871 sssd-ldap.5.xml:1079 msgid "Default: modifyTimestamp" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:369 msgid "ldap_user_shadow_last_change (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:372 msgid "" "When using ldap_pwd_policy=shadow, this parameter contains the name of an " "LDAP attribute corresponding to its <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>shadow</" "refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </citerefentry> counterpart (date of " "the last password change)." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:382 msgid "Default: shadowLastChange" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:388 msgid "ldap_user_shadow_min (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:391 msgid "" "When using ldap_pwd_policy=shadow, this parameter contains the name of an " "LDAP attribute corresponding to its <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>shadow</" "refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </citerefentry> counterpart (minimum " "password age)." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:400 msgid "Default: shadowMin" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:406 msgid "ldap_user_shadow_max (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:409 msgid "" "When using ldap_pwd_policy=shadow, this parameter contains the name of an " "LDAP attribute corresponding to its <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>shadow</" "refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </citerefentry> counterpart (maximum " "password age)." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:418 msgid "Default: shadowMax" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:424 msgid "ldap_user_shadow_warning (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:427 msgid "" "When using ldap_pwd_policy=shadow, this parameter contains the name of an " "LDAP attribute corresponding to its <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>shadow</" "refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </citerefentry> counterpart " "(password warning period)." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:437 msgid "Default: shadowWarning" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:443 msgid "ldap_user_shadow_inactive (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:446 msgid "" "When using ldap_pwd_policy=shadow, this parameter contains the name of an " "LDAP attribute corresponding to its <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>shadow</" "refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </citerefentry> counterpart " "(password inactivity period)." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:456 msgid "Default: shadowInactive" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:462 msgid "ldap_user_shadow_expire (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:465 msgid "" "When using ldap_pwd_policy=shadow or ldap_account_expire_policy=shadow, this " "parameter contains the name of an LDAP attribute corresponding to its " "<citerefentry> <refentrytitle>shadow</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</" "manvolnum> </citerefentry> counterpart (account expiration date)." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:475 msgid "Default: shadowExpire" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:481 msgid "ldap_user_krb_last_pwd_change (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:484 msgid "" "When using ldap_pwd_policy=mit_kerberos, this parameter contains the name of " "an LDAP attribute storing the date and time of last password change in " "kerberos." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:490 msgid "Default: krbLastPwdChange" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:496 msgid "ldap_user_krb_password_expiration (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:499 msgid "" "When using ldap_pwd_policy=mit_kerberos, this parameter contains the name of " "an LDAP attribute storing the date and time when current password expires." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:505 msgid "Default: krbPasswordExpiration" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:511 msgid "ldap_user_ad_account_expires (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:514 msgid "" "When using ldap_account_expire_policy=ad, this parameter contains the name " "of an LDAP attribute storing the expiration time of the account." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:519 msgid "Default: accountExpires" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:525 msgid "ldap_user_ad_user_account_control (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:528 msgid "" "When using ldap_account_expire_policy=ad, this parameter contains the name " "of an LDAP attribute storing the user account control bit field." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:533 msgid "Default: userAccountControl" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:539 msgid "ldap_ns_account_lock (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:542 msgid "" "When using ldap_account_expire_policy=rhds or equivalent, this parameter " "determines if access is allowed or not." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:547 msgid "Default: nsAccountLock" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:553 msgid "ldap_user_nds_login_disabled (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:556 msgid "" "When using ldap_account_expire_policy=nds, this attribute determines if " "access is allowed or not." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:560 sssd-ldap.5.xml:574 msgid "Default: loginDisabled" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:566 msgid "ldap_user_nds_login_expiration_time (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:569 msgid "" "When using ldap_account_expire_policy=nds, this attribute determines until " "which date access is granted." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:580 msgid "ldap_user_nds_login_allowed_time_map (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:583 msgid "" "When using ldap_account_expire_policy=nds, this attribute determines the " "hours of a day in a week when access is granted." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:588 msgid "Default: loginAllowedTimeMap" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:594 msgid "ldap_user_principal (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:597 msgid "" "The LDAP attribute that contains the user's Kerberos User Principal Name " "(UPN)." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:601 msgid "Default: krbPrincipalName" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:607 msgid "ldap_user_extra_attrs (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:610 msgid "" "Comma-separated list of LDAP attributes that SSSD would fetch along with the " "usual set of user attributes." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:615 msgid "" "The list can either contain LDAP attribute names only, or colon-separated " "tuples of SSSD cache attribute name and LDAP attribute name. In case only " "LDAP attribute name is specified, the attribute is saved to the cache " "verbatim. Using a custom SSSD attribute name might be required by " "environments that configure several SSSD domains with different LDAP schemas." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:625 msgid "" "Please note that several attribute names are reserved by SSSD, notably the " "<quote>name</quote> attribute. SSSD would report an error if any of the " "reserved attribute names is used as an extra attribute name." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:635 msgid "ldap_user_extra_attrs = telephoneNumber" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:638 msgid "" "Save the <quote>telephoneNumber</quote> attribute from LDAP as " "<quote>telephoneNumber</quote> to the cache." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:642 msgid "ldap_user_extra_attrs = phone:telephoneNumber" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:645 msgid "" "Save the <quote>telephoneNumber</quote> attribute from LDAP as <quote>phone</" "quote> to the cache." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:655 msgid "ldap_user_ssh_public_key (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:658 msgid "The LDAP attribute that contains the user's SSH public keys." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:662 #, fuzzy #| msgid "Default: true" msgid "Default: sshPublicKey" msgstr "Standaard: true" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:668 msgid "ldap_force_upper_case_realm (boolean)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:671 msgid "" "Some directory servers, for example Active Directory, might deliver the " "realm part of the UPN in lower case, which might cause the authentication to " "fail. Set this option to a non-zero value if you want to use an upper-case " "realm." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:684 msgid "ldap_enumeration_refresh_timeout (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:687 msgid "" "Specifies how many seconds SSSD has to wait before refreshing its cache of " "enumerated records." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:698 msgid "ldap_purge_cache_timeout (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:701 msgid "" "Determine how often to check the cache for inactive entries (such as groups " "with no members and users who have never logged in) and remove them to save " "space." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:707 msgid "Setting this option to zero will disable the cache cleanup operation." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:711 #, fuzzy #| msgid "Default: 120" msgid "Default: 10800 (3 hours)" msgstr "Standaard: 120" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:717 msgid "ldap_user_fullname (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:720 msgid "The LDAP attribute that corresponds to the user's full name." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:724 sssd-ldap.5.xml:817 sssd-ldap.5.xml:1030 #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1104 sssd-ldap.5.xml:2071 sssd-ldap.5.xml:2410 #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:570 msgid "Default: cn" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:730 msgid "ldap_user_member_of (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:733 msgid "The LDAP attribute that lists the user's group memberships." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:737 msgid "Default: memberOf" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:743 msgid "ldap_user_authorized_service (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:746 msgid "" "If access_provider=ldap and ldap_access_order=authorized_service, SSSD will " "use the presence of the authorizedService attribute in the user's LDAP entry " "to determine access privilege." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:753 msgid "" "An explicit deny (!svc) is resolved first. Second, SSSD searches for " "explicit allow (svc) and finally for allow_all (*)." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:758 msgid "" "Please note that the ldap_access_order configuration option <emphasis>must</" "emphasis> include <quote>authorized_service</quote> in order for the " "ldap_user_authorized_service option to work." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:765 msgid "Default: authorizedService" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:771 msgid "ldap_user_authorized_host (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:774 msgid "" "If access_provider=ldap and ldap_access_order=host, SSSD will use the " "presence of the host attribute in the user's LDAP entry to determine access " "privilege." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:780 msgid "" "An explicit deny (!host) is resolved first. Second, SSSD searches for " "explicit allow (host) and finally for allow_all (*)." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:785 msgid "" "Please note that the ldap_access_order configuration option <emphasis>must</" "emphasis> include <quote>host</quote> in order for the " "ldap_user_authorized_host option to work." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:792 msgid "Default: host" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:798 msgid "ldap_group_object_class (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:801 msgid "The object class of a group entry in LDAP." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:804 msgid "Default: posixGroup" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:810 msgid "ldap_group_name (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:813 msgid "The LDAP attribute that corresponds to the group name." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:823 msgid "ldap_group_gid_number (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:826 msgid "The LDAP attribute that corresponds to the group's id." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:836 msgid "ldap_group_member (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:839 msgid "The LDAP attribute that contains the names of the group's members." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:843 msgid "Default: memberuid (rfc2307) / member (rfc2307bis)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:849 msgid "ldap_group_objectsid (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:852 msgid "" "The LDAP attribute that contains the objectSID of an LDAP group object. This " "is usually only necessary for ActiveDirectory servers." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:864 msgid "ldap_group_modify_timestamp (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:877 msgid "ldap_group_type (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:880 msgid "" "The LDAP attribute that contains an integer value indicating the type of the " "group and maybe other flags." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:885 msgid "" "This attribute is currently only used by the AD provider to determine if a " "group is a domain local groups and has to be filtered out for trusted " "domains." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:891 msgid "Default: groupType in the AD provider, othewise not set" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:898 msgid "ldap_group_nesting_level (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:901 msgid "" "If ldap_schema is set to a schema format that supports nested groups (e.g. " "RFC2307bis), then this option controls how many levels of nesting SSSD will " "follow. This option has no effect on the RFC2307 schema." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:908 msgid "" "Note: This option specifies the guaranteed level of nested groups to be " "processed for any lookup. However, nested groups beyond this limit " "<emphasis>may be</emphasis> returned if previous lookups already resolved " "the deeper nesting levels. Also, subsequent lookups for other groups may " "enlarge the result set for original lookup if re-queried." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:917 msgid "" "If ldap_group_nesting_level is set to 0 then no nested groups are processed " "at all. However, when connected to Active-Directory Server 2008 and later it " "is furthermore required to disable usage of Token-Groups by setting " "ldap_use_tokengroups to false." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:924 msgid "Default: 2" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:930 msgid "ldap_groups_use_matching_rule_in_chain" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:933 msgid "" "This option tells SSSD to take advantage of an Active Directory-specific " "feature which may speed up group lookup operations on deployments with " "complex or deep nested groups." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:939 msgid "" "In most common cases, it is best to leave this option disabled. It generally " "only provides a performance increase on very complex nestings." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:944 sssd-ldap.5.xml:971 msgid "" "If this option is enabled, SSSD will use it if it detects that the server " "supports it during initial connection. So \"True\" here essentially means " "\"auto-detect\"." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:950 sssd-ldap.5.xml:977 msgid "" "Note: This feature is currently known to work only with Active Directory " "2008 R1 and later. See <ulink url=\"http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/" "windows/desktop/aa746475%28v=vs.85%29.aspx\"> MSDN(TM) documentation</ulink> " "for more details." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><refsect3><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:956 sssd-ldap.5.xml:983 sssd-ldap.5.xml:1271 #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1292 sssd-ldap.5.xml:1798 include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:242 msgid "Default: False" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:962 msgid "ldap_initgroups_use_matching_rule_in_chain" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:965 msgid "" "This option tells SSSD to take advantage of an Active Directory-specific " "feature which might speed up initgroups operations (most notably when " "dealing with complex or deep nested groups)." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:989 msgid "ldap_use_tokengroups" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:992 msgid "" "This options enables or disables use of Token-Groups attribute when " "performing initgroup for users from Active Directory Server 2008 and later." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:997 sssd-ad.5.xml:742 sss_rpcidmapd.5.xml:76 msgid "Default: True" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1003 msgid "ldap_netgroup_object_class (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1006 msgid "The object class of a netgroup entry in LDAP." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1009 msgid "In IPA provider, ipa_netgroup_object_class should be used instead." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1013 msgid "Default: nisNetgroup" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1019 msgid "ldap_netgroup_name (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1022 msgid "The LDAP attribute that corresponds to the netgroup name." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1026 msgid "In IPA provider, ipa_netgroup_name should be used instead." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1036 msgid "ldap_netgroup_member (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1039 msgid "The LDAP attribute that contains the names of the netgroup's members." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1043 msgid "In IPA provider, ipa_netgroup_member should be used instead." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1047 msgid "Default: memberNisNetgroup" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1053 msgid "ldap_netgroup_triple (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1056 msgid "" "The LDAP attribute that contains the (host, user, domain) netgroup triples." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1060 sssd-ldap.5.xml:1076 msgid "This option is not available in IPA provider." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1063 msgid "Default: nisNetgroupTriple" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1069 msgid "ldap_netgroup_modify_timestamp (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1085 msgid "ldap_service_object_class (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1088 msgid "The object class of a service entry in LDAP." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1091 msgid "Default: ipService" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1097 msgid "ldap_service_name (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1100 msgid "" "The LDAP attribute that contains the name of service attributes and their " "aliases." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1110 msgid "ldap_service_port (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1113 msgid "The LDAP attribute that contains the port managed by this service." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1117 msgid "Default: ipServicePort" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1123 msgid "ldap_service_proto (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1126 msgid "" "The LDAP attribute that contains the protocols understood by this service." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1130 msgid "Default: ipServiceProtocol" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1136 msgid "ldap_service_search_base (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1141 msgid "ldap_search_timeout (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1144 msgid "" "Specifies the timeout (in seconds) that ldap searches are allowed to run " "before they are cancelled and cached results are returned (and offline mode " "is entered)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1150 msgid "" "Note: this option is subject to change in future versions of the SSSD. It " "will likely be replaced at some point by a series of timeouts for specific " "lookup types." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1162 msgid "ldap_enumeration_search_timeout (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1165 msgid "" "Specifies the timeout (in seconds) that ldap searches for user and group " "enumerations are allowed to run before they are cancelled and cached results " "are returned (and offline mode is entered)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1178 msgid "ldap_network_timeout (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1181 msgid "" "Specifies the timeout (in seconds) after which the <citerefentry> " "<refentrytitle>poll</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>2</manvolnum> </citerefentry>/" "<citerefentry> <refentrytitle>select</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>2</" "manvolnum> </citerefentry> following a <citerefentry> " "<refentrytitle>connect</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>2</manvolnum> </" "citerefentry> returns in case of no activity." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1204 msgid "ldap_opt_timeout (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1207 msgid "" "Specifies a timeout (in seconds) after which calls to synchronous LDAP APIs " "will abort if no response is received. Also controls the timeout when " "communicating with the KDC in case of SASL bind." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1219 msgid "ldap_connection_expire_timeout (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1222 msgid "" "Specifies a timeout (in seconds) that a connection to an LDAP server will be " "maintained. After this time, the connection will be re-established. If used " "in parallel with SASL/GSSAPI, the sooner of the two values (this value vs. " "the TGT lifetime) will be used." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1230 sssd-ldap.5.xml:2228 msgid "Default: 900 (15 minutes)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1236 msgid "ldap_page_size (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1239 msgid "" "Specify the number of records to retrieve from LDAP in a single request. " "Some LDAP servers enforce a maximum limit per-request." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1244 msgid "Default: 1000" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1250 msgid "ldap_disable_paging (boolean)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1253 msgid "" "Disable the LDAP paging control. This option should be used if the LDAP " "server reports that it supports the LDAP paging control in its RootDSE but " "it is not enabled or does not behave properly." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1259 msgid "" "Example: OpenLDAP servers with the paging control module installed on the " "server but not enabled will report it in the RootDSE but be unable to use it." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1265 msgid "" "Example: 389 DS has a bug where it can only support a one paging control at " "a time on a single connection. On busy clients, this can result in some " "requests being denied." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1277 msgid "ldap_disable_range_retrieval (boolean)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1280 msgid "Disable Active Directory range retrieval." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1283 msgid "" "Active Directory limits the number of members to be retrieved in a single " "lookup using the MaxValRange policy (which defaults to 1500 members). If a " "group contains more members, the reply would include an AD-specific range " "extension. This option disables parsing of the range extension, therefore " "large groups will appear as having no members." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1298 msgid "ldap_sasl_minssf (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1301 msgid "" "When communicating with an LDAP server using SASL, specify the minimum " "security level necessary to establish the connection. The values of this " "option are defined by OpenLDAP." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1307 msgid "Default: Use the system default (usually specified by ldap.conf)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1314 msgid "ldap_deref_threshold (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1317 msgid "" "Specify the number of group members that must be missing from the internal " "cache in order to trigger a dereference lookup. If less members are missing, " "they are looked up individually." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1323 msgid "" "You can turn off dereference lookups completely by setting the value to 0." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1327 msgid "" "A dereference lookup is a means of fetching all group members in a single " "LDAP call. Different LDAP servers may implement different dereference " "methods. The currently supported servers are 389/RHDS, OpenLDAP and Active " "Directory." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1335 msgid "" "<emphasis>Note:</emphasis> If any of the search bases specifies a search " "filter, then the dereference lookup performance enhancement will be disabled " "regardless of this setting." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1348 msgid "ldap_tls_reqcert (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1351 msgid "" "Specifies what checks to perform on server certificates in a TLS session, if " "any. It can be specified as one of the following values:" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1357 msgid "" "<emphasis>never</emphasis> = The client will not request or check any server " "certificate." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1361 msgid "" "<emphasis>allow</emphasis> = The server certificate is requested. If no " "certificate is provided, the session proceeds normally. If a bad certificate " "is provided, it will be ignored and the session proceeds normally." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1368 msgid "" "<emphasis>try</emphasis> = The server certificate is requested. If no " "certificate is provided, the session proceeds normally. If a bad certificate " "is provided, the session is immediately terminated." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1374 msgid "" "<emphasis>demand</emphasis> = The server certificate is requested. If no " "certificate is provided, or a bad certificate is provided, the session is " "immediately terminated." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1380 msgid "<emphasis>hard</emphasis> = Same as <quote>demand</quote>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1384 msgid "Default: hard" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1390 msgid "ldap_tls_cacert (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1393 msgid "" "Specifies the file that contains certificates for all of the Certificate " "Authorities that <command>sssd</command> will recognize." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1398 sssd-ldap.5.xml:1416 sssd-ldap.5.xml:1457 msgid "" "Default: use OpenLDAP defaults, typically in <filename>/etc/openldap/ldap." "conf</filename>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1405 msgid "ldap_tls_cacertdir (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1408 msgid "" "Specifies the path of a directory that contains Certificate Authority " "certificates in separate individual files. Typically the file names need to " "be the hash of the certificate followed by '.0'. If available, " "<command>cacertdir_rehash</command> can be used to create the correct names." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1423 msgid "ldap_tls_cert (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1426 msgid "Specifies the file that contains the certificate for the client's key." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1436 msgid "ldap_tls_key (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1439 msgid "Specifies the file that contains the client's key." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1448 msgid "ldap_tls_cipher_suite (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1451 msgid "" "Specifies acceptable cipher suites. Typically this is a colon sperated " "list. See <citerefentry><refentrytitle>ldap.conf</refentrytitle> " "<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> for format." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1464 msgid "ldap_id_use_start_tls (boolean)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1467 msgid "" "Specifies that the id_provider connection must also use <systemitem class=" "\"protocol\">tls</systemitem> to protect the channel." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1477 msgid "ldap_id_mapping (boolean)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1480 msgid "" "Specifies that SSSD should attempt to map user and group IDs from the " "ldap_user_objectsid and ldap_group_objectsid attributes instead of relying " "on ldap_user_uid_number and ldap_group_gid_number." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1486 msgid "Currently this feature supports only ActiveDirectory objectSID mapping." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1496 msgid "ldap_min_id, ldap_max_id (interger)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1499 msgid "" "In contrast to the SID based ID mapping which is used if ldap_id_mapping is " "set to true the allowed ID range for ldap_user_uid_number and " "ldap_group_gid_number is unbound. In a setup with sub/trusted-domains this " "might lead to ID collisions. To avoid collisions ldap_min_id and ldap_max_id " "can be set to restrict the allowed range for the IDs which are read directly " "from the server. Sub-domains can then pick other ranges to map IDs." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1511 msgid "Default: not set (both options are set to 0)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1517 msgid "ldap_sasl_mech (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1520 msgid "" "Specify the SASL mechanism to use. Currently only GSSAPI is tested and " "supported." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1530 msgid "ldap_sasl_authid (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1533 msgid "" "Specify the SASL authorization id to use. When GSSAPI is used, this " "represents the Kerberos principal used for authentication to the directory. " "This option can either contain the full principal (for example host/" "myhost@EXAMPLE.COM) or just the principal name (for example host/myhost)." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1541 msgid "Default: host/hostname@REALM" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1547 msgid "ldap_sasl_realm (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1550 msgid "" "Specify the SASL realm to use. When not specified, this option defaults to " "the value of krb5_realm. If the ldap_sasl_authid contains the realm as " "well, this option is ignored." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1556 msgid "Default: the value of krb5_realm." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1562 msgid "ldap_sasl_canonicalize (boolean)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1565 msgid "" "If set to true, the LDAP library would perform a reverse lookup to " "canonicalize the host name during a SASL bind." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1570 msgid "Default: false;" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1576 msgid "ldap_krb5_keytab (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1579 msgid "Specify the keytab to use when using SASL/GSSAPI." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1582 msgid "Default: System keytab, normally <filename>/etc/krb5.keytab</filename>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1588 msgid "ldap_krb5_init_creds (boolean)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1591 msgid "" "Specifies that the id_provider should init Kerberos credentials (TGT). This " "action is performed only if SASL is used and the mechanism selected is " "GSSAPI." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1603 msgid "ldap_krb5_ticket_lifetime (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1606 msgid "Specifies the lifetime in seconds of the TGT if GSSAPI is used." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1610 sssd-ad.5.xml:728 msgid "Default: 86400 (24 hours)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1616 sssd-krb5.5.xml:74 msgid "krb5_server, krb5_backup_server (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1619 msgid "" "Specifies the comma-separated list of IP addresses or hostnames of the " "Kerberos servers to which SSSD should connect in the order of preference. " "For more information on failover and server redundancy, see the " "<quote>FAILOVER</quote> section. An optional port number (preceded by a " "colon) may be appended to the addresses or hostnames. If empty, service " "discovery is enabled - for more information, refer to the <quote>SERVICE " "DISCOVERY</quote> section." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1631 sssd-krb5.5.xml:89 msgid "" "When using service discovery for KDC or kpasswd servers, SSSD first searches " "for DNS entries that specify _udp as the protocol and falls back to _tcp if " "none are found." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1636 sssd-krb5.5.xml:94 msgid "" "This option was named <quote>krb5_kdcip</quote> in earlier releases of SSSD. " "While the legacy name is recognized for the time being, users are advised to " "migrate their config files to use <quote>krb5_server</quote> instead." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1645 sssd-ipa.5.xml:385 sssd-krb5.5.xml:103 msgid "krb5_realm (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1648 msgid "Specify the Kerberos REALM (for SASL/GSSAPI auth)." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1651 msgid "Default: System defaults, see <filename>/etc/krb5.conf</filename>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1657 sssd-ipa.5.xml:400 sssd-krb5.5.xml:453 msgid "krb5_canonicalize (boolean)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1660 msgid "" "Specifies if the host principal should be canonicalized when connecting to " "LDAP server. This feature is available with MIT Kerberos >= 1.7" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1672 sssd-krb5.5.xml:468 msgid "krb5_use_kdcinfo (boolean)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1675 sssd-krb5.5.xml:471 msgid "" "Specifies if the SSSD should instruct the Kerberos libraries what realm and " "which KDCs to use. This option is on by default, if you disable it, you need " "to configure the Kerberos library using the <citerefentry> " "<refentrytitle>krb5.conf</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </" "citerefentry> configuration file." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1686 sssd-krb5.5.xml:482 msgid "" "See the <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sssd_krb5_locator_plugin</" "refentrytitle> <manvolnum>8</manvolnum> </citerefentry> manual page for more " "information on the locator plugin." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1700 msgid "ldap_pwd_policy (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1703 msgid "" "Select the policy to evaluate the password expiration on the client side. " "The following values are allowed:" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1708 msgid "" "<emphasis>none</emphasis> - No evaluation on the client side. This option " "cannot disable server-side password policies." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1713 msgid "" "<emphasis>shadow</emphasis> - Use <citerefentry><refentrytitle>shadow</" "refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> style attributes to " "evaluate if the password has expired." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1719 msgid "" "<emphasis>mit_kerberos</emphasis> - Use the attributes used by MIT Kerberos " "to determine if the password has expired. Use chpass_provider=krb5 to update " "these attributes when the password is changed." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1728 msgid "" "<emphasis>Note</emphasis>: if a password policy is configured on server " "side, it always takes precedence over policy set with this option." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1736 msgid "ldap_referrals (boolean)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1739 msgid "Specifies whether automatic referral chasing should be enabled." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1743 msgid "" "Please note that sssd only supports referral chasing when it is compiled " "with OpenLDAP version 2.4.13 or higher." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1748 msgid "" "Chasing referrals may incur a performance penalty in environments that use " "them heavily, a notable example is Microsoft Active Directory. If your setup " "does not in fact require the use of referrals, setting this option to false " "might bring a noticeable performance improvement." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1762 msgid "ldap_dns_service_name (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1765 msgid "Specifies the service name to use when service discovery is enabled." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1769 msgid "Default: ldap" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1775 msgid "ldap_chpass_dns_service_name (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1778 msgid "" "Specifies the service name to use to find an LDAP server which allows " "password changes when service discovery is enabled." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1783 msgid "Default: not set, i.e. service discovery is disabled" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1789 msgid "ldap_chpass_update_last_change (bool)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1792 msgid "" "Specifies whether to update the ldap_user_shadow_last_change attribute with " "days since the Epoch after a password change operation." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1804 msgid "ldap_access_filter (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1807 msgid "" "If using access_provider = ldap and ldap_access_order = filter (default), " "this option is mandatory. It specifies an LDAP search filter criteria that " "must be met for the user to be granted access on this host. If " "access_provider = ldap, ldap_access_order = filter and this option is not " "set, it will result in all users being denied access. Use access_provider = " "permit to change this default behavior. Please note that this filter is " "applied on the LDAP user entry only and thus filtering based on nested " "groups may not work (e.g. memberOf attribute on AD entries points only to " "direct parents). If filtering based on nested groups is required, please see " "<citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sssd-simple</refentrytitle><manvolnum>5</" "manvolnum> </citerefentry>." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1827 msgid "Example:" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><programlisting> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1830 #, no-wrap msgid "" "access_provider = ldap\n" "ldap_access_filter = (employeeType=admin)\n" " " msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1834 msgid "" "This example means that access to this host is restricted to users whose " "employeeType attribute is set to \"admin\"." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1839 msgid "" "Offline caching for this feature is limited to determining whether the " "user's last online login was granted access permission. If they were granted " "access during their last login, they will continue to be granted access " "while offline and vice-versa." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1847 sssd-ldap.5.xml:1904 msgid "Default: Empty" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1853 msgid "ldap_account_expire_policy (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1856 msgid "" "With this option a client side evaluation of access control attributes can " "be enabled." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1860 msgid "" "Please note that it is always recommended to use server side access control, " "i.e. the LDAP server should deny the bind request with a suitable error code " "even if the password is correct." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1867 msgid "The following values are allowed:" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1870 msgid "" "<emphasis>shadow</emphasis>: use the value of ldap_user_shadow_expire to " "determine if the account is expired." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1875 msgid "" "<emphasis>ad</emphasis>: use the value of the 32bit field " "ldap_user_ad_user_account_control and allow access if the second bit is not " "set. If the attribute is missing access is granted. Also the expiration time " "of the account is checked." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1882 msgid "" "<emphasis>rhds</emphasis>, <emphasis>ipa</emphasis>, <emphasis>389ds</" "emphasis>: use the value of ldap_ns_account_lock to check if access is " "allowed or not." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1888 msgid "" "<emphasis>nds</emphasis>: the values of " "ldap_user_nds_login_allowed_time_map, ldap_user_nds_login_disabled and " "ldap_user_nds_login_expiration_time are used to check if access is allowed. " "If both attributes are missing access is granted." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1897 msgid "" "Please note that the ldap_access_order configuration option <emphasis>must</" "emphasis> include <quote>expire</quote> in order for the " "ldap_account_expire_policy option to work." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1910 msgid "ldap_access_order (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1913 msgid "Comma separated list of access control options. Allowed values are:" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1917 msgid "<emphasis>filter</emphasis>: use ldap_access_filter" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1920 msgid "" "<emphasis>lockout</emphasis>: use account locking. If set, this option " "denies access in case that ldap attribute 'pwdAccountLockedTime' is present " "and has value of '000001010000Z'. Please see the option ldap_pwdlockout_dn." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1927 msgid "<emphasis>expire</emphasis>: use ldap_account_expire_policy" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1931 msgid "" "<emphasis>authorized_service</emphasis>: use the authorizedService attribute " "to determine access" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1936 msgid "<emphasis>host</emphasis>: use the host attribute to determine access" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1940 msgid "Default: filter" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1943 msgid "" "Please note that it is a configuration error if a value is used more than " "once." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1950 msgid "ldap_pwdlockout_dn (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1953 msgid "" "This option specifies the DN of password policy entry on LDAP server. Please " "note that absence of this option in sssd.conf in case of enabled account " "lockout checking will yield access denied as ppolicy attributes on LDAP " "server cannot be checked properly." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1961 msgid "Example: cn=ppolicy,ou=policies,dc=example,dc=com" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1964 msgid "Default: cn=ppolicy,ou=policies,$ldap_search_base" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1970 msgid "ldap_deref (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1973 msgid "" "Specifies how alias dereferencing is done when performing a search. The " "following options are allowed:" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1978 msgid "<emphasis>never</emphasis>: Aliases are never dereferenced." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1982 msgid "" "<emphasis>searching</emphasis>: Aliases are dereferenced in subordinates of " "the base object, but not in locating the base object of the search." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1987 msgid "" "<emphasis>finding</emphasis>: Aliases are only dereferenced when locating " "the base object of the search." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1992 msgid "" "<emphasis>always</emphasis>: Aliases are dereferenced both in searching and " "in locating the base object of the search." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:1997 msgid "" "Default: Empty (this is handled as <emphasis>never</emphasis> by the LDAP " "client libraries)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2005 msgid "ldap_rfc2307_fallback_to_local_users (boolean)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2008 msgid "" "Allows to retain local users as members of an LDAP group for servers that " "use the RFC2307 schema." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2012 msgid "" "In some environments where the RFC2307 schema is used, local users are made " "members of LDAP groups by adding their names to the memberUid attribute. " "The self-consistency of the domain is compromised when this is done, so SSSD " "would normally remove the \"missing\" users from the cached group " "memberships as soon as nsswitch tries to fetch information about the user " "via getpw*() or initgroups() calls." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2023 msgid "" "This option falls back to checking if local users are referenced, and caches " "them so that later initgroups() calls will augment the local users with the " "additional LDAP groups." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:51 msgid "" "All of the common configuration options that apply to SSSD domains also " "apply to LDAP domains. Refer to the <quote>DOMAIN SECTIONS</quote> section " "of the <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sssd.conf</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</" "manvolnum> </citerefentry> manual page for full details. <placeholder type=" "\"variablelist\" id=\"0\"/>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><title> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2039 msgid "SUDO OPTIONS" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2041 msgid "" "The detailed instructions for configuration of sudo_provider are in the " "manual page <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sssd-sudo</refentrytitle> " "<manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </citerefentry>." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2052 msgid "ldap_sudorule_object_class (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2055 msgid "The object class of a sudo rule entry in LDAP." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2058 msgid "Default: sudoRole" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2064 msgid "ldap_sudorule_name (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2067 msgid "The LDAP attribute that corresponds to the sudo rule name." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2077 msgid "ldap_sudorule_command (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2080 msgid "The LDAP attribute that corresponds to the command name." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2084 msgid "Default: sudoCommand" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2090 msgid "ldap_sudorule_host (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2093 msgid "" "The LDAP attribute that corresponds to the host name (or host IP address, " "host IP network, or host netgroup)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2098 msgid "Default: sudoHost" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2104 msgid "ldap_sudorule_user (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2107 msgid "" "The LDAP attribute that corresponds to the user name (or UID, group name or " "user's netgroup)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2111 msgid "Default: sudoUser" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2117 msgid "ldap_sudorule_option (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2120 msgid "The LDAP attribute that corresponds to the sudo options." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2124 msgid "Default: sudoOption" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2130 msgid "ldap_sudorule_runasuser (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2133 msgid "" "The LDAP attribute that corresponds to the user name that commands may be " "run as." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2137 msgid "Default: sudoRunAsUser" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2143 msgid "ldap_sudorule_runasgroup (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2146 msgid "" "The LDAP attribute that corresponds to the group name or group GID that " "commands may be run as." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2150 msgid "Default: sudoRunAsGroup" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2156 msgid "ldap_sudorule_notbefore (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2159 msgid "" "The LDAP attribute that corresponds to the start date/time for when the sudo " "rule is valid." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2163 msgid "Default: sudoNotBefore" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2169 msgid "ldap_sudorule_notafter (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2172 msgid "" "The LDAP attribute that corresponds to the expiration date/time, after which " "the sudo rule will no longer be valid." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2177 msgid "Default: sudoNotAfter" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2183 msgid "ldap_sudorule_order (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2186 msgid "The LDAP attribute that corresponds to the ordering index of the rule." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2190 msgid "Default: sudoOrder" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2196 msgid "ldap_sudo_full_refresh_interval (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2199 msgid "" "How many seconds SSSD will wait between executing a full refresh of sudo " "rules (which downloads all rules that are stored on the server)." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2204 msgid "" "The value must be greater than <emphasis>ldap_sudo_smart_refresh_interval </" "emphasis>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2209 msgid "Default: 21600 (6 hours)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2215 msgid "ldap_sudo_smart_refresh_interval (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2218 msgid "" "How many seconds SSSD has to wait before executing a smart refresh of sudo " "rules (which downloads all rules that have USN higher than the highest USN " "of cached rules)." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2224 msgid "" "If USN attributes are not supported by the server, the modifyTimestamp " "attribute is used instead." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2234 msgid "ldap_sudo_use_host_filter (boolean)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2237 msgid "" "If true, SSSD will download only rules that are applicable to this machine " "(using the IPv4 or IPv6 host/network addresses and hostnames)." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2248 msgid "ldap_sudo_hostnames (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2251 msgid "" "Space separated list of hostnames or fully qualified domain names that " "should be used to filter the rules." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2256 msgid "" "If this option is empty, SSSD will try to discover the hostname and the " "fully qualified domain name automatically." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2261 sssd-ldap.5.xml:2284 sssd-ldap.5.xml:2302 #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2320 msgid "" "If <emphasis>ldap_sudo_use_host_filter</emphasis> is <emphasis>false</" "emphasis> then this option has no effect." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2266 sssd-ldap.5.xml:2289 msgid "Default: not specified" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2272 msgid "ldap_sudo_ip (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2275 msgid "" "Space separated list of IPv4 or IPv6 host/network addresses that should be " "used to filter the rules." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2280 msgid "" "If this option is empty, SSSD will try to discover the addresses " "automatically." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2295 msgid "ldap_sudo_include_netgroups (boolean)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2298 msgid "" "If true then SSSD will download every rule that contains a netgroup in " "sudoHost attribute." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2313 msgid "ldap_sudo_include_regexp (boolean)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2316 msgid "" "If true then SSSD will download every rule that contains a wildcard in " "sudoHost attribute." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2332 msgid "" "This manual page only describes attribute name mapping. For detailed " "explanation of sudo related attribute semantics, see <citerefentry> " "<refentrytitle>sudoers.ldap</refentrytitle><manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </" "citerefentry>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><title> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2342 msgid "AUTOFS OPTIONS" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2344 msgid "" "Please note that the default values correspond to the default schema which " "is RFC2307." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2350 msgid "ldap_autofs_map_master_name (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2353 msgid "The name of the automount master map in LDAP." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2356 msgid "Default: auto.master" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2363 msgid "ldap_autofs_map_object_class (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2366 sssd-ldap.5.xml:2392 msgid "The object class of an automount map entry in LDAP." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2369 sssd-ldap.5.xml:2396 msgid "Default: automountMap" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2376 msgid "ldap_autofs_map_name (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2379 msgid "The name of an automount map entry in LDAP." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2382 msgid "Default: ou" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2389 msgid "ldap_autofs_entry_object_class (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2403 msgid "ldap_autofs_entry_key (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2406 sssd-ldap.5.xml:2420 msgid "" "The key of an automount entry in LDAP. The entry usually corresponds to a " "mount point." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2417 msgid "ldap_autofs_entry_value (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2424 msgid "Default: automountInformation" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2348 msgid "" "<placeholder type=\"variablelist\" id=\"0\"/> <placeholder type=" "\"variablelist\" id=\"1\"/> <placeholder type=\"variablelist\" id=\"2\"/> " "<placeholder type=\"variablelist\" id=\"3\"/> <placeholder type=" "\"variablelist\" id=\"4\"/> <placeholder type=\"variablelist\" id=\"5\"/>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><title> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2434 msgid "ADVANCED OPTIONS" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2441 msgid "ldap_netgroup_search_base (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2446 msgid "ldap_user_search_base (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2451 msgid "ldap_group_search_base (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2456 msgid "ldap_sudo_search_base (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2461 msgid "ldap_autofs_search_base (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2436 msgid "" "These options are supported by LDAP domains, but they should be used with " "caution. Please include them in your configuration only if you know what you " "are doing. <placeholder type=\"variablelist\" id=\"0\"/>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2478 msgid "" "The following example assumes that SSSD is correctly configured and LDAP is " "set to one of the domains in the <replaceable>[domains]</replaceable> " "section." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><programlisting> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2484 #, no-wrap msgid "" " [domain/LDAP]\n" " id_provider = ldap\n" " auth_provider = ldap\n" " ldap_uri = ldap://ldap.mydomain.org\n" " ldap_search_base = dc=mydomain,dc=org\n" " ldap_tls_reqcert = demand\n" " cache_credentials = true\n" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2483 sssd-simple.5.xml:139 sssd-ipa.5.xml:702 #: sssd-ad.5.xml:800 sssd-sudo.5.xml:56 sssd-sudo.5.xml:98 sssd-krb5.5.xml:528 #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:105 msgid "<placeholder type=\"programlisting\" id=\"0\"/>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><title> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2496 sssd_krb5_locator_plugin.8.xml:61 #: sssd-simple.5.xml:148 sssd-ad.5.xml:815 sssd.8.xml:195 sss_seed.8.xml:163 msgid "NOTES" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-ldap.5.xml:2498 msgid "" "The descriptions of some of the configuration options in this manual page " "are based on the <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>ldap.conf</refentrytitle> " "<manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </citerefentry> manual page from the OpenLDAP 2.4 " "distribution." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refentryinfo> #: pam_sss.8.xml:8 include/upstream.xml:2 msgid "" "<productname>SSSD</productname> <orgname>The SSSD upstream - http://" "fedorahosted.org/sssd</orgname>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refname> #: pam_sss.8.xml:13 pam_sss.8.xml:18 msgid "pam_sss" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refpurpose> #: pam_sss.8.xml:19 msgid "PAM module for SSSD" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsynopsisdiv><cmdsynopsis> #: pam_sss.8.xml:24 msgid "" "<command>pam_sss.so</command> <arg choice='opt'> <replaceable>quiet</" "replaceable> </arg> <arg choice='opt'> <replaceable>forward_pass</" "replaceable> </arg> <arg choice='opt'> <replaceable>use_first_pass</" "replaceable> </arg> <arg choice='opt'> <replaceable>use_authtok</" "replaceable> </arg> <arg choice='opt'> <replaceable>retry=N</replaceable> </" "arg> <arg choice='opt'> <replaceable>ignore_unknown_user</replaceable> </" "arg> <arg choice='opt'> <replaceable>ignore_authinfo_unavail</replaceable> </" "arg> <arg choice='opt'> <replaceable>domains=X</replaceable> </arg>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: pam_sss.8.xml:54 msgid "" "<command>pam_sss.so</command> is the PAM interface to the System Security " "Services daemon (SSSD). Errors and results are logged through " "<command>syslog(3)</command> with the LOG_AUTHPRIV facility." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: pam_sss.8.xml:64 msgid "<option>quiet</option>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: pam_sss.8.xml:67 msgid "Suppress log messages for unknown users." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: pam_sss.8.xml:72 msgid "<option>forward_pass</option>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: pam_sss.8.xml:75 msgid "" "If <option>forward_pass</option> is set the entered password is put on the " "stack for other PAM modules to use." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: pam_sss.8.xml:82 msgid "<option>use_first_pass</option>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: pam_sss.8.xml:85 msgid "" "The argument use_first_pass forces the module to use a previous stacked " "modules password and will never prompt the user - if no password is " "available or the password is not appropriate, the user will be denied access." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: pam_sss.8.xml:93 msgid "<option>use_authtok</option>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: pam_sss.8.xml:96 msgid "" "When password changing enforce the module to set the new password to the one " "provided by a previously stacked password module." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: pam_sss.8.xml:103 msgid "<option>retry=N</option>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: pam_sss.8.xml:106 msgid "" "If specified the user is asked another N times for a password if " "authentication fails. Default is 0." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: pam_sss.8.xml:108 msgid "" "Please note that this option might not work as expected if the application " "calling PAM handles the user dialog on its own. A typical example is " "<command>sshd</command> with <option>PasswordAuthentication</option>." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: pam_sss.8.xml:117 msgid "<option>ignore_unknown_user</option>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: pam_sss.8.xml:120 msgid "" "If this option is specified and the user does not exist, the PAM module will " "return PAM_IGNORE. This causes the PAM framework to ignore this module." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: pam_sss.8.xml:127 msgid "<option>ignore_authinfo_unavail</option>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: pam_sss.8.xml:131 msgid "" "Specifies that the PAM module should return PAM_IGNORE if it cannot contact " "the SSSD daemon. This causes the PAM framework to ignore this module." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: pam_sss.8.xml:138 msgid "<option>domains</option>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: pam_sss.8.xml:142 msgid "" "Allows the administrator to restrict the domains a particular PAM service is " "allowed to authenticate against. The format is a comma-separated list of " "SSSD domain names, as specified in the sssd.conf file." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: pam_sss.8.xml:148 msgid "" "NOTE: Must be used in conjunction with the <quote>pam_trusted_users</quote> " "and <quote>pam_public_domains</quote> options. Please see the " "<citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sssd.conf</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</" "manvolnum> </citerefentry> manual page for more information on these two PAM " "responder options." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><title> #: pam_sss.8.xml:164 msgid "MODULE TYPES PROVIDED" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: pam_sss.8.xml:165 msgid "" "All module types (<option>account</option>, <option>auth</option>, " "<option>password</option> and <option>session</option>) are provided." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><title> #: pam_sss.8.xml:171 msgid "FILES" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: pam_sss.8.xml:172 msgid "" "If a password reset by root fails, because the corresponding SSSD provider " "does not support password resets, an individual message can be displayed. " "This message can e.g. contain instructions about how to reset a password." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: pam_sss.8.xml:177 msgid "" "The message is read from the file <filename>pam_sss_pw_reset_message.LOC</" "filename> where LOC stands for a locale string returned by <citerefentry> " "<refentrytitle>setlocale</refentrytitle><manvolnum>3</manvolnum> </" "citerefentry>. If there is no matching file the content of " "<filename>pam_sss_pw_reset_message.txt</filename> is displayed. Root must be " "the owner of the files and only root may have read and write permissions " "while all other users must have only read permissions." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: pam_sss.8.xml:187 msgid "" "These files are searched in the directory <filename>/etc/sssd/customize/" "DOMAIN_NAME/</filename>. If no matching file is present a generic message is " "displayed." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refname> #: sssd_krb5_locator_plugin.8.xml:10 sssd_krb5_locator_plugin.8.xml:15 msgid "sssd_krb5_locator_plugin" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refpurpose> #: sssd_krb5_locator_plugin.8.xml:16 msgid "Kerberos locator plugin" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd_krb5_locator_plugin.8.xml:22 msgid "" "The Kerberos locator plugin <command>sssd_krb5_locator_plugin</command> is " "used by the Kerberos provider of <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sssd</" "refentrytitle> <manvolnum>8</manvolnum> </citerefentry> to tell the Kerberos " "libraries what Realm and which KDC to use. Typically this is done in " "<citerefentry> <refentrytitle>krb5.conf</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</" "manvolnum> </citerefentry> which is always read by the Kerberos libraries. " "To simplify the configuration the Realm and the KDC can be defined in " "<citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sssd.conf</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</" "manvolnum> </citerefentry> as described in <citerefentry> " "<refentrytitle>sssd-krb5</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </" "citerefentry>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd_krb5_locator_plugin.8.xml:48 msgid "" "<citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sssd</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>8</manvolnum> " "</citerefentry> puts the Realm and the name or IP address of the KDC into " "the environment variables SSSD_KRB5_REALM and SSSD_KRB5_KDC respectively. " "When <command>sssd_krb5_locator_plugin</command> is called by the kerberos " "libraries it reads and evaluates these variables and returns them to the " "libraries." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd_krb5_locator_plugin.8.xml:63 msgid "" "Not all Kerberos implementations support the use of plugins. If " "<command>sssd_krb5_locator_plugin</command> is not available on your system " "you have to edit /etc/krb5.conf to reflect your Kerberos setup." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd_krb5_locator_plugin.8.xml:69 msgid "" "If the environment variable SSSD_KRB5_LOCATOR_DEBUG is set to any value " "debug messages will be sent to stderr." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refname> #: sssd-simple.5.xml:10 sssd-simple.5.xml:16 msgid "sssd-simple" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refpurpose> #: sssd-simple.5.xml:17 msgid "the configuration file for SSSD's 'simple' access-control provider" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-simple.5.xml:24 msgid "" "This manual page describes the configuration of the simple access-control " "provider for <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sssd</refentrytitle> " "<manvolnum>8</manvolnum> </citerefentry>. For a detailed syntax reference, " "refer to the <quote>FILE FORMAT</quote> section of the <citerefentry> " "<refentrytitle>sssd.conf</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </" "citerefentry> manual page." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-simple.5.xml:38 msgid "" "The simple access provider grants or denies access based on an access or " "deny list of user or group names. The following rules apply:" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd-simple.5.xml:43 msgid "If all lists are empty, access is granted" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd-simple.5.xml:47 msgid "" "If any list is provided, the order of evaluation is allow,deny. This means " "that any matching deny rule will supersede any matched allow rule." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd-simple.5.xml:54 msgid "" "If either or both \"allow\" lists are provided, all users are denied unless " "they appear in the list." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd-simple.5.xml:60 msgid "" "If only \"deny\" lists are provided, all users are granted access unless " "they appear in the list." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-simple.5.xml:78 msgid "simple_allow_users (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-simple.5.xml:81 msgid "Comma separated list of users who are allowed to log in." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-simple.5.xml:88 msgid "simple_deny_users (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-simple.5.xml:91 msgid "Comma separated list of users who are explicitly denied access." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-simple.5.xml:97 msgid "simple_allow_groups (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-simple.5.xml:100 msgid "" "Comma separated list of groups that are allowed to log in. This applies only " "to groups within this SSSD domain. Local groups are not evaluated." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-simple.5.xml:108 msgid "simple_deny_groups (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-simple.5.xml:111 msgid "" "Comma separated list of groups that are explicitly denied access. This " "applies only to groups within this SSSD domain. Local groups are not " "evaluated." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-simple.5.xml:70 sssd-ipa.5.xml:71 sssd-ad.5.xml:89 msgid "" "Refer to the section <quote>DOMAIN SECTIONS</quote> of the <citerefentry> " "<refentrytitle>sssd.conf</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </" "citerefentry> manual page for details on the configuration of an SSSD " "domain. <placeholder type=\"variablelist\" id=\"0\"/>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-simple.5.xml:120 msgid "" "Specifying no values for any of the lists is equivalent to skipping it " "entirely. Beware of this while generating parameters for the simple provider " "using automated scripts." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-simple.5.xml:125 msgid "" "Please note that it is an configuration error if both, simple_allow_users " "and simple_deny_users, are defined." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-simple.5.xml:133 msgid "" "The following example assumes that SSSD is correctly configured and example." "com is one of the domains in the <replaceable>[sssd]</replaceable> section. " "This examples shows only the simple access provider-specific options." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><programlisting> #: sssd-simple.5.xml:140 #, no-wrap msgid "" " [domain/example.com]\n" " access_provider = simple\n" " simple_allow_users = user1, user2\n" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-simple.5.xml:150 msgid "" "The complete group membership hierarchy is resolved before the access check, " "thus even nested groups can be included in the access lists. Please be " "aware that the <quote>ldap_group_nesting_level</quote> option may impact the " "results and should be set to a sufficient value. (<citerefentry> " "<refentrytitle>sssd-ldap</refentrytitle><manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </" "citerefentry>) option." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refname> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:10 sssd-ipa.5.xml:16 msgid "sssd-ipa" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refpurpose> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:17 msgid "SSSD IPA provider" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:23 msgid "" "This manual page describes the configuration of the IPA provider for " "<citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sssd</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>8</manvolnum> " "</citerefentry>. For a detailed syntax reference, refer to the <quote>FILE " "FORMAT</quote> section of the <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sssd.conf</" "refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </citerefentry> manual page." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:36 msgid "" "The IPA provider is a back end used to connect to an IPA server. (Refer to " "the freeipa.org web site for information about IPA servers.) This provider " "requires that the machine be joined to the IPA domain; configuration is " "almost entirely self-discovered and obtained directly from the server." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:43 msgid "" "The IPA provider accepts the same options used by the <citerefentry> " "<refentrytitle>sssd-ldap</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </" "citerefentry> identity provider and the <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sssd-" "krb5</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </citerefentry> authentication " "provider with some exceptions described below." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:55 msgid "" "However, it is neither necessary nor recommended to set these options. IPA " "provider can also be used as an access and chpass provider. As an access " "provider it uses HBAC (host-based access control) rules. Please refer to " "freeipa.org for more information about HBAC. No configuration of access " "provider is required on the client side." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:62 msgid "" "The IPA provider will use the PAC responder if the Kerberos tickets of users " "from trusted realms contain a PAC. To make configuration easier the PAC " "responder is started automatically if the IPA ID provider is configured." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:78 msgid "ipa_domain (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:81 msgid "" "Specifies the name of the IPA domain. This is optional. If not provided, " "the configuration domain name is used." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:89 msgid "ipa_server, ipa_backup_server (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:92 msgid "" "The comma-separated list of IP addresses or hostnames of the IPA servers to " "which SSSD should connect in the order of preference. For more information " "on failover and server redundancy, see the <quote>FAILOVER</quote> section. " "This is optional if autodiscovery is enabled. For more information on " "service discovery, refer to the <quote>SERVICE DISCOVERY</quote> section." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:105 msgid "ipa_hostname (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:108 msgid "" "Optional. May be set on machines where the hostname(5) does not reflect the " "fully qualified name used in the IPA domain to identify this host." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:116 sssd-ad.5.xml:665 msgid "dyndns_update (boolean)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:119 msgid "" "Optional. This option tells SSSD to automatically update the DNS server " "built into FreeIPA v2 with the IP address of this client. The update is " "secured using GSS-TSIG. The IP address of the IPA LDAP connection is used " "for the updates, if it is not otherwise specified by using the " "<quote>dyndns_iface</quote> option." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:128 sssd-ad.5.xml:679 msgid "" "NOTE: On older systems (such as RHEL 5), for this behavior to work reliably, " "the default Kerberos realm must be set properly in /etc/krb5.conf" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:133 msgid "" "NOTE: While it is still possible to use the old <emphasis>ipa_dyndns_update</" "emphasis> option, users should migrate to using <emphasis>dyndns_update</" "emphasis> in their config file." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:145 sssd-ad.5.xml:690 msgid "dyndns_ttl (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:148 sssd-ad.5.xml:693 msgid "" "The TTL to apply to the client DNS record when updating it. If " "dyndns_update is false this has no effect. This will override the TTL " "serverside if set by an administrator." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:153 msgid "" "NOTE: While it is still possible to use the old <emphasis>ipa_dyndns_ttl</" "emphasis> option, users should migrate to using <emphasis>dyndns_ttl</" "emphasis> in their config file." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:159 msgid "Default: 1200 (seconds)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:165 sssd-ad.5.xml:704 msgid "dyndns_iface (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:168 sssd-ad.5.xml:707 msgid "" "Optional. Applicable only when dyndns_update is true. Choose the interface " "whose IP address should be used for dynamic DNS updates." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:173 msgid "" "NOTE: While it is still possible to use the old <emphasis>ipa_dyndns_iface</" "emphasis> option, users should migrate to using <emphasis>dyndns_iface</" "emphasis> in their config file." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:179 msgid "Default: Use the IP address of the IPA LDAP connection" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:185 msgid "ipa_enable_dns_sites (boolean)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:188 sssd-ad.5.xml:152 msgid "Enables DNS sites - location based service discovery." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:192 msgid "" "If true and service discovery (see Service Discovery paragraph at the bottom " "of the man page) is enabled, then the SSSD will first attempt location " "based discovery using a query that contains \"_location.hostname.example.com" "\" and then fall back to traditional SRV discovery. If the location based " "discovery succeeds, the IPA servers located with the location based " "discovery are treated as primary servers and the IPA servers located using " "the traditional SRV discovery are used as back up servers" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:211 sssd-ad.5.xml:718 msgid "dyndns_refresh_interval (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:214 sssd-ad.5.xml:721 msgid "" "How often should the back end perform periodic DNS update in addition to the " "automatic update performed when the back end goes online. This option is " "optional and applicable only when dyndns_update is true." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:227 sssd-ad.5.xml:734 msgid "dyndns_update_ptr (bool)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:230 sssd-ad.5.xml:737 msgid "" "Whether the PTR record should also be explicitly updated when updating the " "client's DNS records. Applicable only when dyndns_update is true." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:235 msgid "" "This option should be False in most IPA deployments as the IPA server " "generates the PTR records automatically when forward records are changed." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:241 msgid "Default: False (disabled)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:247 sssd-ad.5.xml:748 msgid "dyndns_force_tcp (bool)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:250 sssd-ad.5.xml:751 msgid "" "Whether the nsupdate utility should default to using TCP for communicating " "with the DNS server." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:254 sssd-ad.5.xml:755 msgid "Default: False (let nsupdate choose the protocol)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:260 msgid "ipa_hbac_search_base (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:263 msgid "Optional. Use the given string as search base for HBAC related objects." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:267 msgid "Default: Use base DN" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:273 msgid "ipa_host_search_base (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:276 msgid "Optional. Use the given string as search base for host objects." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:280 sssd-ipa.5.xml:299 sssd-ipa.5.xml:318 sssd-ipa.5.xml:337 #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:356 msgid "" "See <quote>ldap_search_base</quote> for information about configuring " "multiple search bases." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:285 sssd-ipa.5.xml:304 include/ldap_search_bases.xml:27 msgid "Default: the value of <emphasis>ldap_search_base</emphasis>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:292 msgid "ipa_selinux_search_base (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:295 msgid "Optional. Use the given string as search base for SELinux user maps." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:311 msgid "ipa_subdomains_search_base (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:314 msgid "Optional. Use the given string as search base for trusted domains." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:323 msgid "Default: the value of <emphasis>cn=trusts,%basedn</emphasis>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:330 msgid "ipa_master_domain_search_base (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:333 msgid "Optional. Use the given string as search base for master domain object." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:342 msgid "Default: the value of <emphasis>cn=ad,cn=etc,%basedn</emphasis>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:349 msgid "ipa_views_search_base (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:352 msgid "Optional. Use the given string as search base for views containers." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:361 msgid "Default: the value of <emphasis>cn=views,cn=accounts,%basedn</emphasis>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:368 sssd-krb5.5.xml:245 msgid "krb5_validate (boolean)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:371 msgid "" "Verify with the help of krb5_keytab that the TGT obtained has not been " "spoofed." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:378 sssd-ad.5.xml:776 msgid "" "Note that this default differs from the traditional Kerberos provider back " "end." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:388 msgid "" "The name of the Kerberos realm. This is optional and defaults to the value " "of <quote>ipa_domain</quote>." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:392 msgid "" "The name of the Kerberos realm has a special meaning in IPA - it is " "converted into the base DN to use for performing LDAP operations." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:403 msgid "" "Specifies if the host and user principal should be canonicalized when " "connecting to IPA LDAP and also for AS requests. This feature is available " "with MIT Kerberos >= 1.7" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:416 sssd-krb5.5.xml:407 msgid "krb5_use_fast (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:419 sssd-krb5.5.xml:410 msgid "" "Enables flexible authentication secure tunneling (FAST) for Kerberos pre-" "authentication. The following options are supported:" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:424 msgid "<emphasis>never</emphasis> use FAST." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:427 msgid "" "<emphasis>try</emphasis> to use FAST. If the server does not support FAST, " "continue the authentication without it. This is equivalent to not setting " "this option at all." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:433 sssd-krb5.5.xml:424 msgid "" "<emphasis>demand</emphasis> to use FAST. The authentication fails if the " "server does not require fast." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:438 msgid "Default: try" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:441 sssd-krb5.5.xml:435 msgid "" "NOTE: SSSD supports FAST only with MIT Kerberos version 1.8 and later. If " "SSSD is used with an older version of MIT Kerberos, using this option is a " "configuration error." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:450 msgid "ipa_hbac_refresh (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:453 msgid "" "The amount of time between lookups of the HBAC rules against the IPA server. " "This will reduce the latency and load on the IPA server if there are many " "access-control requests made in a short period." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:460 sssd-ipa.5.xml:476 sssd-ad.5.xml:330 msgid "Default: 5 (seconds)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:466 msgid "ipa_hbac_selinux (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:469 msgid "" "The amount of time between lookups of the SELinux maps against the IPA " "server. This will reduce the latency and load on the IPA server if there are " "many user login requests made in a short period." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:482 msgid "ipa_hbac_treat_deny_as (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:485 msgid "" "This option specifies how to treat the deprecated DENY-type HBAC rules. As " "of FreeIPA v2.1, DENY rules are no longer supported on the server. All users " "of FreeIPA will need to migrate their rules to use only the ALLOW rules. The " "client will support two modes of operation during this transition period:" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:494 msgid "" "<emphasis>DENY_ALL</emphasis>: If any HBAC DENY rules are detected, all " "users will be denied access." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:499 msgid "" "<emphasis>IGNORE</emphasis>: SSSD will ignore any DENY rules. Be very " "careful with this option, as it may result in opening unintended access." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:504 msgid "Default: DENY_ALL" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:510 msgid "ipa_server_mode (boolean)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:513 msgid "This option should only be set by the IPA installer." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:517 msgid "" "The option denotes that the SSSD is running on IPA server and should perform " "lookups of users and groups from trusted domains differently." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:528 msgid "ipa_automount_location (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:531 msgid "The automounter location this IPA client will be using" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:534 msgid "Default: The location named \"default\"" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><title> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:542 msgid "VIEWS AND OVERRIDES" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:551 msgid "ipa_view_class (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:554 msgid "Objectclass of the view container." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:557 #, fuzzy #| msgid "Default: true" msgid "Default: nsContainer" msgstr "Standaard: true" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:563 msgid "ipa_view_name (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:566 msgid "Name of the attribute holding the name of the view." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:576 msgid "ipa_overide_object_class (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:579 msgid "Objectclass of the override objects." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:582 msgid "Default: ipaOverrideAnchor" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:588 msgid "ipa_anchor_uuid (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:591 msgid "" "Name of the attribute containing the reference to the original object in a " "remote domain." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:595 msgid "Default: ipaAnchorUUID" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:601 msgid "ipa_user_override_object_class (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:604 msgid "" "Name of the objectclass for user overrides. It is used to determine if the " "found override object is related to a user or a group." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:609 msgid "User overrides can contain attributes given by" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:612 msgid "ldap_user_name" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:615 msgid "ldap_user_uid_number" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:618 msgid "ldap_user_gid_number" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:621 msgid "ldap_user_gecos" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:624 msgid "ldap_user_home_directory" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:627 msgid "ldap_user_shell" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:632 msgid "Default: ipaUserOverride" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:638 msgid "ipa_group_override_object_class (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:641 msgid "" "Name of the objectclass for group overrides. It is used to determine if the " "found override object is related to a user or a group." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:646 msgid "Group overrides can contain attributes given by" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:649 msgid "ldap_group_name" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:652 msgid "ldap_group_gid_number" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:657 #, fuzzy #| msgid "Default: true" msgid "Default: ipaGroupOverride" msgstr "Standaard: true" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:544 msgid "" "SSSD can handle views and overrides which are offered by FreeIPA 4.1 and " "later version. Since all paths and objectclasses are fixed on the server " "side there is basically no need to configure anything. For completeness the " "related options are listed here with their default values. <placeholder " "type=\"variablelist\" id=\"0\"/>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><title> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:667 msgid "SUBDOMAINS PROVIDER" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:669 msgid "" "The IPA subdomains provider behaves slightly differently if it is configured " "explicitly or implicitly." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:673 msgid "" "If the option 'subdomains_provider = ipa' is found in the domain section of " "sssd.conf, the IPA subdomains provider is configured explicitly, and all " "subdomain requests are sent to the IPA server if necessary." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:679 msgid "" "If the option 'subdomains_provider' is not set in the domain section of sssd." "conf but there is the option 'id_provider = ipa', the IPA subdomains " "provider is configured implicitly. In this case, if a subdomain request " "fails and indicates that the server does not support subdomains, i.e. is not " "configured for trusts, the IPA subdomains provider is disabled. After an " "hour or after the IPA provider goes online, the subdomains provider is " "enabled again." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:696 msgid "" "The following example assumes that SSSD is correctly configured and example." "com is one of the domains in the <replaceable>[sssd]</replaceable> section. " "This examples shows only the ipa provider-specific options." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><programlisting> #: sssd-ipa.5.xml:703 #, no-wrap msgid "" " [domain/example.com]\n" " id_provider = ipa\n" " ipa_server = ipaserver.example.com\n" " ipa_hostname = myhost.example.com\n" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refname> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:10 sssd-ad.5.xml:16 msgid "sssd-ad" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refpurpose> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:17 msgid "SSSD Active Directory provider" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:23 msgid "" "This manual page describes the configuration of the AD provider for " "<citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sssd</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>8</manvolnum> " "</citerefentry>. For a detailed syntax reference, refer to the <quote>FILE " "FORMAT</quote> section of the <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sssd.conf</" "refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </citerefentry> manual page." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:36 msgid "" "The AD provider is a back end used to connect to an Active Directory server. " "This provider requires that the machine be joined to the AD domain and a " "keytab is available." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:41 msgid "" "The AD provider supports connecting to Active Directory 2008 R2 or later. " "Earlier versions may work, but are unsupported." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:45 msgid "" "The AD provider is able to provide identity information and authentication " "for entities from trusted domains as well. Currently only trusted domains in " "the same forest are recognized." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:50 msgid "" "The AD provider accepts the same options used by the <citerefentry> " "<refentrytitle>sssd-ldap</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </" "citerefentry> identity provider and the <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sssd-" "krb5</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </citerefentry> authentication " "provider with some exceptions described below." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:62 msgid "" "However, it is neither necessary nor recommended to set these options. The " "AD provider can also be used as an access, chpass and sudo provider. No " "configuration of the access provider is required on the client side." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><programlisting> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:74 #, no-wrap msgid "" "ldap_id_mapping = False\n" " " msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:68 msgid "" "By default, the AD provider will map UID and GID values from the objectSID " "parameter in Active Directory. For details on this, see the <quote>ID " "MAPPING</quote> section below. If you want to disable ID mapping and instead " "rely on POSIX attributes defined in Active Directory, you should set " "<placeholder type=\"programlisting\" id=\"0\"/> In order to retrieve users " "and groups using POSIX attributes from trusted domains, the AD administrator " "must make sure that the POSIX attributes are replicated to the Global " "Catalog." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:81 msgid "" "Users, groups and other entities served by SSSD are always treated as case-" "insensitive in the AD provider for compatibility with Active Directory's " "LDAP implementation." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:96 msgid "ad_domain (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:99 msgid "" "Specifies the name of the Active Directory domain. This is optional. If not " "provided, the configuration domain name is used." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:104 msgid "" "For proper operation, this option should be specified as the lower-case " "version of the long version of the Active Directory domain." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:109 msgid "" "The short domain name (also known as the NetBIOS or the flat name) is " "autodetected by the SSSD." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:116 msgid "ad_server, ad_backup_server (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:119 msgid "" "The comma-separated list of hostnames of the AD servers to which SSSD should " "connect in order of preference. For more information on failover and server " "redundancy, see the <quote>FAILOVER</quote> section. This is optional if " "autodiscovery is enabled. For more information on service discovery, refer " "to the <quote>SERVICE DISCOVERY</quote> section." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:132 msgid "ad_hostname (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:135 msgid "" "Optional. May be set on machines where the hostname(5) does not reflect the " "fully qualified name used in the Active Directory domain to identify this " "host." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:141 msgid "" "This field is used to determine the host principal in use in the keytab. It " "must match the hostname for which the keytab was issued." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:149 msgid "ad_enable_dns_sites (boolean)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:156 msgid "" "If true and service discovery (see Service Discovery paragraph at the bottom " "of the man page) is enabled, the SSSD will first attempt to discover the " "Active Directory server to connect to using the Active Directory Site " "Discovery and fall back to the DNS SRV records if no AD site is found. The " "DNS SRV configuration, including the discovery domain, is used during site " "discovery as well." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:172 msgid "ad_access_filter (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:175 msgid "" "This option specifies LDAP access control filter that the user must match in " "order to be allowed access. Please note that the <quote>access_provider</" "quote> option must be explicitly set to <quote>ad</quote> in order for this " "option to have an effect." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:183 msgid "" "The option also supports specifying different filters per domain or forest. " "This extended filter would consist of: <quote>KEYWORD:NAME:FILTER</quote>. " "The keyword can be either <quote>DOM</quote>, <quote>FOREST</quote> or " "missing." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:191 msgid "" "If the keyword equals to <quote>DOM</quote> or is missing, then <quote>NAME</" "quote> specifies the domain or subdomain the filter applies to. If the " "keyword equals to <quote>FOREST</quote>, then the filter equals to all " "domains from the forest specified by <quote>NAME</quote>." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:199 msgid "" "Multiple filters can be separated with the <quote>?</quote> character, " "similarly to how search bases work." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:204 msgid "" "The most specific match is always used. For example, if the option specified " "filter for a domain the user is a member of and a global filter, the per-" "domain filter would be applied. If there are more matches with the same " "specification, the first one is used." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><programlisting> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:215 #, no-wrap msgid "" "# apply filter on domain called dom1 only:\n" "dom1:(memberOf=cn=admins,ou=groups,dc=dom1,dc=com)\n" "\n" "# apply filter on domain called dom2 only:\n" "DOM:dom2:(memberOf=cn=admins,ou=groups,dc=dom2,dc=com)\n" "\n" "# apply filter on forest called EXAMPLE.COM only:\n" "FOREST:EXAMPLE.COM:(memberOf=cn=admins,ou=groups,dc=example,dc=com)\n" " " msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:225 msgid "Default: Not set" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:231 msgid "ad_enable_gc (boolean)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:234 msgid "" "By default, the SSSD connects to the Global Catalog first to retrieve users " "from trusted domains and uses the LDAP port to retrieve group memberships or " "as a fallback. Disabling this option makes the SSSD only connect to the LDAP " "port of the current AD server." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:242 msgid "" "Please note that disabling Global Catalog support does not disable " "retrieving users from trusted domains. The SSSD would connect to the LDAP " "port of trusted domains instead. However, Global Catalog must be used in " "order to resolve cross-domain group memberships." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:256 msgid "ad_gpo_access_control (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:259 msgid "" "This option specifies the operation mode for GPO-based access control " "functionality: whether it operates in disabled mode, enforcing mode, or " "permissive mode. Please note that the <quote>access_provider</quote> option " "must be explicitly set to <quote>ad</quote> in order for this option to have " "an effect." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:268 msgid "" "GPO-based access control functionality uses GPO policy settings to determine " "whether or not a particular user is allowed to logon to a particular host." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:274 msgid "" "NOTE: If the operation mode is set to enforcing, it is possible that users " "that were previously allowed logon access will now be denied logon access " "(as dictated by the GPO policy settings). In order to facilitate a smooth " "transition for administrators, a permissive mode is available that will not " "enforce the access control rules, but will evaluate them and will output a " "syslog message if access would have been denied. By examining the logs, " "administrators can then make the necessary changes before setting the mode " "to enforcing." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:287 msgid "There are three supported values for this option:" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:291 msgid "" "disabled: GPO-based access control rules are neither evaluated nor enforced." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:297 msgid "enforcing: GPO-based access control rules are evaluated and enforced." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:303 msgid "" "permissive: GPO-based access control rules are evaluated, but not enforced. " "Instead, a syslog message will be emitted indicating that the user would " "have been denied access if this option's value were set to enforcing." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:314 msgid "Default: permissive" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:320 #, fuzzy #| msgid "enum_cache_timeout (integer)" msgid "ad_gpo_cache_timeout (integer)" msgstr "enum_cache_timeout (numeriek)" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:323 msgid "" "The amount of time between lookups of GPO policy files against the AD " "server. This will reduce the latency and load on the AD server if there are " "many access-control requests made in a short period." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:336 msgid "ad_gpo_map_interactive (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:339 msgid "" "A comma-separated list of PAM service names for which GPO-based access " "control is evaluated based on the InteractiveLogonRight and " "DenyInteractiveLogonRight policy settings." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><programlisting> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:354 #, no-wrap msgid "" " ad_gpo_map_interactive = +my_pam_service, -login\n" " " msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:345 msgid "" "It is possible to add another PAM service name to the default set by using " "<quote>+service_name</quote> or to explicitly remove a PAM service name from " "the default set by using <quote>-service_name</quote>. For example, in " "order to replace a default PAM service name for this logon right (e.g. " "<quote>login</quote>) with a custom pam service name (e.g. " "<quote>my_pam_service</quote>), you would use the following configuration: " "<placeholder type=\"programlisting\" id=\"0\"/>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:358 sssd-ad.5.xml:423 sssd-ad.5.xml:458 sssd-ad.5.xml:498 #: sssd-ad.5.xml:559 msgid "Default: the default set of PAM service names includes:" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:362 msgid "login" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:367 msgid "su" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:372 msgid "su-l" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:377 msgid "gdm-fingerprint" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:382 msgid "gdm-password" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:387 msgid "gdm-smartcard" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:392 msgid "kdm" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:401 msgid "ad_gpo_map_remote_interactive (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:404 msgid "" "A comma-separated list of PAM service names for which GPO-based access " "control is evaluated based on the RemoteInteractiveLogonRight and " "DenyRemoteInteractiveLogonRight policy settings." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><programlisting> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:419 #, no-wrap msgid "" " ad_gpo_map_remote_interactive = +my_pam_service, -sshd\n" " " msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:410 msgid "" "It is possible to add another PAM service name to the default set by using " "<quote>+service_name</quote> or to explicitly remove a PAM service name from " "the default set by using <quote>-service_name</quote>. For example, in " "order to replace a default PAM service name for this logon right (e.g. " "<quote>sshd</quote>) with a custom pam service name (e.g. " "<quote>my_pam_service</quote>), you would use the following configuration: " "<placeholder type=\"programlisting\" id=\"0\"/>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:427 msgid "sshd" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:436 msgid "ad_gpo_map_network (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:439 msgid "" "A comma-separated list of PAM service names for which GPO-based access " "control is evaluated based on the NetworkLogonRight and " "DenyNetworkLogonRight policy settings." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><programlisting> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:454 #, no-wrap msgid "" " ad_gpo_map_network = +my_pam_service, -ftp\n" " " msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:445 msgid "" "It is possible to add another PAM service name to the default set by using " "<quote>+service_name</quote> or to explicitly remove a PAM service name from " "the default set by using <quote>-service_name</quote>. For example, in " "order to replace a default PAM service name for this logon right (e.g. " "<quote>ftp</quote>) with a custom pam service name (e.g. " "<quote>my_pam_service</quote>), you would use the following configuration: " "<placeholder type=\"programlisting\" id=\"0\"/>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:462 msgid "ftp" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:467 msgid "samba" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:476 #, fuzzy #| msgid "full_name_format (string)" msgid "ad_gpo_map_batch (string)" msgstr "full_name_format (tekst)" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:479 msgid "" "A comma-separated list of PAM service names for which GPO-based access " "control is evaluated based on the BatchLogonRight and DenyBatchLogonRight " "policy settings." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><programlisting> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:494 #, no-wrap msgid "" " ad_gpo_map_batch = +my_pam_service, -crond\n" " " msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:485 msgid "" "It is possible to add another PAM service name to the default set by using " "<quote>+service_name</quote> or to explicitly remove a PAM service name from " "the default set by using <quote>-service_name</quote>. For example, in " "order to replace a default PAM service name for this logon right (e.g. " "<quote>crond</quote>) with a custom pam service name (e.g. " "<quote>my_pam_service</quote>), you would use the following configuration: " "<placeholder type=\"programlisting\" id=\"0\"/>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:502 msgid "crond" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:511 msgid "ad_gpo_map_service (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:514 msgid "" "A comma-separated list of PAM service names for which GPO-based access " "control is evaluated based on the ServiceLogonRight and " "DenyServiceLogonRight policy settings." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><programlisting> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:528 #, no-wrap msgid "" " ad_gpo_map_service = +my_pam_service\n" " " msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:520 sssd-ad.5.xml:585 msgid "" "It is possible to add a PAM service name to the default set by using <quote>" "+service_name</quote>. Since the default set is empty, it is not possible " "to remove a PAM service name from the default set. For example, in order to " "add a custom pam service name (e.g. <quote>my_pam_service</quote>), you " "would use the following configuration: <placeholder type=\"programlisting\" " "id=\"0\"/>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:538 msgid "ad_gpo_map_permit (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:541 msgid "" "A comma-separated list of PAM service names for which GPO-based access is " "always granted, regardless of any GPO Logon Rights." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><programlisting> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:555 #, no-wrap msgid "" " ad_gpo_map_permit = +my_pam_service, -sudo\n" " " msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:546 msgid "" "It is possible to add another PAM service name to the default set by using " "<quote>+service_name</quote> or to explicitly remove a PAM service name from " "the default set by using <quote>-service_name</quote>. For example, in " "order to replace a default PAM service name for unconditionally permitted " "access (e.g. <quote>sudo</quote>) with a custom pam service name (e.g. " "<quote>my_pam_service</quote>), you would use the following configuration: " "<placeholder type=\"programlisting\" id=\"0\"/>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:563 msgid "sudo" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:568 msgid "sudo-i" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:577 msgid "ad_gpo_map_deny (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:580 msgid "" "A comma-separated list of PAM service names for which GPO-based access is " "always denied, regardless of any GPO Logon Rights." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><programlisting> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:593 #, no-wrap msgid "" " ad_gpo_map_deny = +my_pam_service\n" " " msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:603 msgid "ad_gpo_default_right (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:606 msgid "" "This option defines how access control is evaluated for PAM service names " "that are not explicitly listed in one of the ad_gpo_map_* options. This " "option can be set in two different manners. First, this option can be set to " "use a default logon right. For example, if this option is set to " "'interactive', it means that unmapped PAM service names will be processed " "based on the InteractiveLogonRight and DenyInteractiveLogonRight policy " "settings. Alternatively, this option can be set to either always permit or " "always deny access for unmapped PAM service names." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:619 msgid "Supported values for this option include:" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:623 msgid "interactive" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:628 msgid "remote_interactive" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:633 msgid "network" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:638 msgid "batch" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:643 #, fuzzy #| msgid "services" msgid "service" msgstr "diensten" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:648 msgid "permit" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:653 msgid "deny" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:659 #, fuzzy #| msgid "Default: 3" msgid "Default: deny" msgstr "Standaard: 3" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:668 msgid "" "Optional. This option tells SSSD to automatically update the Active " "Directory DNS server with the IP address of this client. The update is " "secured using GSS-TSIG. As a consequence, the Active Directory administrator " "only needs to allow secure updates for the DNS zone. The IP address of the " "AD LDAP connection is used for the updates, if it is not otherwise specified " "by using the <quote>dyndns_iface</quote> option." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:698 msgid "Default: 3600 (seconds)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:712 msgid "Default: Use the IP address of the AD LDAP connection" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:764 sssd-krb5.5.xml:496 msgid "krb5_use_enterprise_principal (boolean)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:767 sssd-krb5.5.xml:499 msgid "" "Specifies if the user principal should be treated as enterprise principal. " "See section 5 of RFC 6806 for more details about enterprise principals." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:794 msgid "" "The following example assumes that SSSD is correctly configured and example." "com is one of the domains in the <replaceable>[sssd]</replaceable> section. " "This example shows only the AD provider-specific options." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><programlisting> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:801 #, no-wrap msgid "" "[domain/EXAMPLE]\n" "id_provider = ad\n" "auth_provider = ad\n" "access_provider = ad\n" "chpass_provider = ad\n" "\n" "ad_server = dc1.example.com\n" "ad_hostname = client.example.com\n" "ad_domain = example.com\n" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><programlisting> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:821 #, no-wrap msgid "" "access_provider = ldap\n" "ldap_access_order = expire\n" "ldap_account_expire_policy = ad\n" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:817 msgid "" "The AD access control provider checks if the account is expired. It has the " "same effect as the following configuration of the LDAP provider: " "<placeholder type=\"programlisting\" id=\"0\"/>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-ad.5.xml:827 msgid "" "However, unless the <quote>ad</quote> access control provider is explicitly " "configured, the default access provider is <quote>permit</quote>. Please " "note that if you configure an access provider other than <quote>ad</quote>, " "you need to set all the connection parameters (such as LDAP URIs and " "encryption details) manually." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refname> #: sssd-sudo.5.xml:10 sssd-sudo.5.xml:16 msgid "sssd-sudo" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refpurpose> #: sssd-sudo.5.xml:17 msgid "Configuring sudo with the SSSD back end" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-sudo.5.xml:23 msgid "" "This manual page describes how to configure <citerefentry> " "<refentrytitle>sudo</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>8</manvolnum> </citerefentry> " "to work with <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sssd</refentrytitle> " "<manvolnum>8</manvolnum> </citerefentry> and how SSSD caches sudo rules." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><title> #: sssd-sudo.5.xml:36 msgid "Configuring sudo to cooperate with SSSD" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-sudo.5.xml:38 msgid "" "To enable SSSD as a source for sudo rules, add <emphasis>sss</emphasis> to " "the <emphasis>sudoers</emphasis> entry in <citerefentry> " "<refentrytitle>nsswitch.conf</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </" "citerefentry>." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-sudo.5.xml:47 msgid "" "For example, to configure sudo to first lookup rules in the standard " "<citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sudoers</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</" "manvolnum> </citerefentry> file (which should contain rules that apply to " "local users) and then in SSSD, the nsswitch.conf file should contain the " "following line:" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><programlisting> #: sssd-sudo.5.xml:57 #, no-wrap msgid "sudoers: files sss\n" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-sudo.5.xml:61 msgid "" "More information about configuring the sudoers search order from the " "nsswitch.conf file as well as information about the LDAP schema that is used " "to store sudo rules in the directory can be found in <citerefentry> " "<refentrytitle>sudoers.ldap</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </" "citerefentry>." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-sudo.5.xml:70 msgid "" "<emphasis>Note</emphasis>: in order to use netgroups or IPA hostgroups in " "sudo rules, you also need to correctly set <citerefentry> " "<refentrytitle>nisdomainname</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>1</manvolnum> </" "citerefentry> to your NIS domain name (which equals to IPA domain name when " "using hostgroups)." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><title> #: sssd-sudo.5.xml:82 msgid "Configuring SSSD to fetch sudo rules" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-sudo.5.xml:84 msgid "" "All configuration that is needed on SSSD side is to extend the list of " "<emphasis>services</emphasis> with \"sudo\" in [sssd] section of " "<citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sssd.conf</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</" "manvolnum> </citerefentry>. To speed up the LDAP lookups, you can also set " "search base for sudo rules using <emphasis>ldap_sudo_search_base</emphasis> " "option." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-sudo.5.xml:94 msgid "" "The following example shows how to configure SSSD to download sudo rules " "from an LDAP server." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><programlisting> #: sssd-sudo.5.xml:99 #, no-wrap msgid "" "[sssd]\n" "config_file_version = 2\n" "services = nss, pam, sudo\n" "domains = EXAMPLE\n" "\n" "[domain/EXAMPLE]\n" "id_provider = ldap\n" "sudo_provider = ldap\n" "ldap_uri = ldap://example.com\n" "ldap_sudo_search_base = ou=sudoers,dc=example,dc=com\n" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-sudo.5.xml:112 msgid "" "When the SSSD is configured to use IPA as the ID provider, the sudo provider " "is automatically enabled. The sudo search base is configured to use the " "compat tree (ou=sudoers,$DC)." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><title> #: sssd-sudo.5.xml:119 msgid "The SUDO rule caching mechanism" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-sudo.5.xml:121 msgid "" "The biggest challenge, when developing sudo support in SSSD, was to ensure " "that running sudo with SSSD as the data source provides the same user " "experience and is as fast as sudo but keeps providing the most current set " "of rules as possible. To satisfy these requirements, SSSD uses three kinds " "of updates. They are referred to as full refresh, smart refresh and rules " "refresh." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-sudo.5.xml:129 msgid "" "The <emphasis>smart refresh</emphasis> periodically downloads rules that are " "new or were modified after the last update. Its primary goal is to keep the " "database growing by fetching only small increments that do not generate " "large amounts of network traffic." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-sudo.5.xml:135 msgid "" "The <emphasis>full refresh</emphasis> simply deletes all sudo rules stored " "in the cache and replaces them with all rules that are stored on the server. " "This is used to keep the cache consistent by removing every rule which was " "deleted from the server. However, full refresh may produce a lot of traffic " "and thus it should be run only occasionally depending on the size and " "stability of the sudo rules." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-sudo.5.xml:143 msgid "" "The <emphasis>rules refresh</emphasis> ensures that we do not grant the user " "more permission than defined. It is triggered each time the user runs sudo. " "Rules refresh will find all rules that apply to this user, check their " "expiration time and redownload them if expired. In the case that any of " "these rules are missing on the server, the SSSD will do an out of band full " "refresh because more rules (that apply to other users) may have been deleted." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-sudo.5.xml:152 msgid "" "If enabled, SSSD will store only rules that can be applied to this machine. " "This means rules that contain one of the following values in " "<emphasis>sudoHost</emphasis> attribute:" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd-sudo.5.xml:159 msgid "keyword ALL" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd-sudo.5.xml:164 msgid "wildcard" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd-sudo.5.xml:169 msgid "netgroup (in the form \"+netgroup\")" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd-sudo.5.xml:174 msgid "hostname or fully qualified domain name of this machine" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd-sudo.5.xml:179 msgid "one of the IP addresses of this machine" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: sssd-sudo.5.xml:184 msgid "one of the IP addresses of the network (in the form \"address/mask\")" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-sudo.5.xml:190 msgid "" "There are many configuration options that can be used to adjust the " "behavior. Please refer to \"ldap_sudo_*\" in <citerefentry> " "<refentrytitle>sssd-ldap</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </" "citerefentry> and \"sudo_*\" in <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sssd.conf</" "refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </citerefentry>." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refname> #: sssd.8.xml:10 sssd.8.xml:15 msgid "sssd" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refpurpose> #: sssd.8.xml:16 msgid "System Security Services Daemon" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsynopsisdiv><cmdsynopsis> #: sssd.8.xml:21 msgid "" "<command>sssd</command> <arg choice='opt'> <replaceable>options</" "replaceable> </arg>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd.8.xml:31 msgid "" "<command>SSSD</command> provides a set of daemons to manage access to remote " "directories and authentication mechanisms. It provides an NSS and PAM " "interface toward the system and a pluggable backend system to connect to " "multiple different account sources as well as D-Bus interface. It is also " "the basis to provide client auditing and policy services for projects like " "FreeIPA. It provides a more robust database to store local users as well as " "extended user data." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.8.xml:46 msgid "" "<option>-d</option>,<option>--debug-level</option> <replaceable>LEVEL</" "replaceable>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.8.xml:53 msgid "<option>--debug-timestamps=</option><replaceable>mode</replaceable>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.8.xml:57 msgid "<emphasis>1</emphasis>: Add a timestamp to the debug messages" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.8.xml:60 msgid "<emphasis>0</emphasis>: Disable timestamp in the debug messages" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.8.xml:69 msgid "<option>--debug-microseconds=</option><replaceable>mode</replaceable>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.8.xml:73 msgid "" "<emphasis>1</emphasis>: Add microseconds to the timestamp in debug messages" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.8.xml:76 msgid "<emphasis>0</emphasis>: Disable microseconds in timestamp" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.8.xml:85 msgid "<option>-f</option>,<option>--debug-to-files</option>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.8.xml:89 msgid "" "Send the debug output to files instead of stderr. By default, the log files " "are stored in <filename>/var/log/sssd</filename> and there are separate log " "files for every SSSD service and domain." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.8.xml:97 msgid "<option>-D</option>,<option>--daemon</option>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.8.xml:101 msgid "Become a daemon after starting up." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.8.xml:107 sss_seed.8.xml:136 msgid "<option>-i</option>,<option>--interactive</option>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.8.xml:111 msgid "Run in the foreground, don't become a daemon." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.8.xml:117 sss_debuglevel.8.xml:42 msgid "<option>-c</option>,<option>--config</option>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.8.xml:121 sss_debuglevel.8.xml:46 msgid "" "Specify a non-default config file. The default is <filename>/etc/sssd/sssd." "conf</filename>. For reference on the config file syntax and options, " "consult the <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sssd.conf</refentrytitle> " "<manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </citerefentry> manual page." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.8.xml:135 msgid "<option>--version</option>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.8.xml:139 msgid "Print version number and exit." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><title> #: sssd.8.xml:147 msgid "Signals" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.8.xml:150 msgid "SIGTERM/SIGINT" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.8.xml:153 msgid "" "Informs the SSSD to gracefully terminate all of its child processes and then " "shut down the monitor." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.8.xml:159 msgid "SIGHUP" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.8.xml:162 msgid "" "Tells the SSSD to stop writing to its current debug file descriptors and to " "close and reopen them. This is meant to facilitate log rolling with programs " "like logrotate." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.8.xml:170 msgid "SIGUSR1" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.8.xml:173 msgid "" "Tells the SSSD to simulate offline operation for the duration of the " "<quote>offline_timeout</quote> parameter. This is useful for testing. The " "signal can be sent to either the sssd process or any sssd_be process " "directly." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd.8.xml:182 msgid "SIGUSR2" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd.8.xml:185 msgid "" "Tells the SSSD to go online immediately. This is useful for testing. The " "signal can be sent to either the sssd process or any sssd_be process " "directly." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd.8.xml:197 msgid "" "If the environment variable SSS_NSS_USE_MEMCACHE is set to \"NO\", client " "applications will not use the fast in memory cache." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refname> #: sss_obfuscate.8.xml:10 sss_obfuscate.8.xml:15 msgid "sss_obfuscate" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refpurpose> #: sss_obfuscate.8.xml:16 msgid "obfuscate a clear text password" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsynopsisdiv><cmdsynopsis> #: sss_obfuscate.8.xml:21 msgid "" "<command>sss_obfuscate</command> <arg choice='opt'> <replaceable>options</" "replaceable> </arg> <arg choice='plain'><replaceable>[PASSWORD]</" "replaceable></arg>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sss_obfuscate.8.xml:32 msgid "" "<command>sss_obfuscate</command> converts a given password into human-" "unreadable format and places it into appropriate domain section of the SSSD " "config file." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sss_obfuscate.8.xml:37 msgid "" "The cleartext password is read from standard input or entered " "interactively. The obfuscated password is put into " "<quote>ldap_default_authtok</quote> parameter of a given SSSD domain and the " "<quote>ldap_default_authtok_type</quote> parameter is set to " "<quote>obfuscated_password</quote>. Refer to <citerefentry> " "<refentrytitle>sssd-ldap</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </" "citerefentry> for more details on these parameters." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sss_obfuscate.8.xml:49 msgid "" "Please note that obfuscating the password provides <emphasis>no real " "security benefit</emphasis> as it is still possible for an attacker to " "reverse-engineer the password back. Using better authentication mechanisms " "such as client side certificates or GSSAPI is <emphasis>strongly</emphasis> " "advised." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sss_obfuscate.8.xml:63 msgid "<option>-s</option>,<option>--stdin</option>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_obfuscate.8.xml:67 msgid "The password to obfuscate will be read from standard input." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sss_obfuscate.8.xml:74 sss_ssh_authorizedkeys.1.xml:79 #: sss_ssh_knownhostsproxy.1.xml:78 msgid "" "<option>-d</option>,<option>--domain</option> <replaceable>DOMAIN</" "replaceable>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_obfuscate.8.xml:79 msgid "" "The SSSD domain to use the password in. The default name is <quote>default</" "quote>." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sss_obfuscate.8.xml:86 msgid "" "<option>-f</option>,<option>--file</option> <replaceable>FILE</replaceable>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_obfuscate.8.xml:91 msgid "Read the config file specified by the positional parameter." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_obfuscate.8.xml:95 msgid "Default: <filename>/etc/sssd/sssd.conf</filename>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refname> #: sss_useradd.8.xml:10 sss_useradd.8.xml:15 msgid "sss_useradd" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refpurpose> #: sss_useradd.8.xml:16 msgid "create a new user" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsynopsisdiv><cmdsynopsis> #: sss_useradd.8.xml:21 msgid "" "<command>sss_useradd</command> <arg choice='opt'> <replaceable>options</" "replaceable> </arg> <arg choice='plain'><replaceable>LOGIN</replaceable></" "arg>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sss_useradd.8.xml:32 msgid "" "<command>sss_useradd</command> creates a new user account using the values " "specified on the command line plus the default values from the system." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sss_useradd.8.xml:43 sss_seed.8.xml:76 msgid "" "<option>-u</option>,<option>--uid</option> <replaceable>UID</replaceable>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_useradd.8.xml:48 msgid "" "Set the UID of the user to the value of <replaceable>UID</replaceable>. If " "not given, it is chosen automatically." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sss_useradd.8.xml:55 sss_usermod.8.xml:43 sss_seed.8.xml:100 msgid "" "<option>-c</option>,<option>--gecos</option> <replaceable>COMMENT</" "replaceable>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_useradd.8.xml:60 sss_usermod.8.xml:48 sss_seed.8.xml:105 msgid "" "Any text string describing the user. Often used as the field for the user's " "full name." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sss_useradd.8.xml:67 sss_usermod.8.xml:55 sss_seed.8.xml:112 msgid "" "<option>-h</option>,<option>--home</option> <replaceable>HOME_DIR</" "replaceable>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_useradd.8.xml:72 msgid "" "The home directory of the user account. The default is to append the " "<replaceable>LOGIN</replaceable> name to <filename>/home</filename> and use " "that as the home directory. The base that is prepended before " "<replaceable>LOGIN</replaceable> is tunable with <quote>user_defaults/" "baseDirectory</quote> setting in sssd.conf." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sss_useradd.8.xml:82 sss_usermod.8.xml:66 sss_seed.8.xml:124 msgid "" "<option>-s</option>,<option>--shell</option> <replaceable>SHELL</replaceable>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_useradd.8.xml:87 msgid "" "The user's login shell. The default is currently <filename>/bin/bash</" "filename>. The default can be changed with <quote>user_defaults/" "defaultShell</quote> setting in sssd.conf." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sss_useradd.8.xml:96 msgid "" "<option>-G</option>,<option>--groups</option> <replaceable>GROUPS</" "replaceable>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_useradd.8.xml:101 msgid "A list of existing groups this user is also a member of." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sss_useradd.8.xml:107 msgid "<option>-m</option>,<option>--create-home</option>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_useradd.8.xml:111 msgid "" "Create the user's home directory if it does not exist. The files and " "directories contained in the skeleton directory (which can be defined with " "the -k option or in the config file) will be copied to the home directory." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sss_useradd.8.xml:121 msgid "<option>-M</option>,<option>--no-create-home</option>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_useradd.8.xml:125 msgid "" "Do not create the user's home directory. Overrides configuration settings." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sss_useradd.8.xml:132 msgid "" "<option>-k</option>,<option>--skel</option> <replaceable>SKELDIR</" "replaceable>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_useradd.8.xml:137 msgid "" "The skeleton directory, which contains files and directories to be copied in " "the user's home directory, when the home directory is created by " "<command>sss_useradd</command>." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_useradd.8.xml:143 msgid "" "Special files (block devices, character devices, named pipes and unix " "sockets) will not be copied." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_useradd.8.xml:147 msgid "" "This option is only valid if the <option>-m</option> (or <option>--create-" "home</option>) option is specified, or creation of home directories is set " "to TRUE in the configuration." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sss_useradd.8.xml:156 sss_usermod.8.xml:124 msgid "" "<option>-Z</option>,<option>--selinux-user</option> " "<replaceable>SELINUX_USER</replaceable>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_useradd.8.xml:161 msgid "" "The SELinux user for the user's login. If not specified, the system default " "will be used." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refname> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:10 sssd-krb5.5.xml:16 msgid "sssd-krb5" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refpurpose> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:17 msgid "SSSD Kerberos provider" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:23 msgid "" "This manual page describes the configuration of the Kerberos 5 " "authentication backend for <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sssd</" "refentrytitle> <manvolnum>8</manvolnum> </citerefentry>. For a detailed " "syntax reference, please refer to the <quote>FILE FORMAT</quote> section of " "the <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sssd.conf</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</" "manvolnum> </citerefentry> manual page." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:36 msgid "" "The Kerberos 5 authentication backend contains auth and chpass providers. It " "must be paired with an identity provider in order to function properly (for " "example, id_provider = ldap). Some information required by the Kerberos 5 " "authentication backend must be provided by the identity provider, such as " "the user's Kerberos Principal Name (UPN). The configuration of the identity " "provider should have an entry to specify the UPN. Please refer to the man " "page for the applicable identity provider for details on how to configure " "this." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:47 msgid "" "This backend also provides access control based on the .k5login file in the " "home directory of the user. See <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>.k5login</" "refentrytitle><manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </citerefentry> for more details. " "Please note that an empty .k5login file will deny all access to this user. " "To activate this feature, use 'access_provider = krb5' in your SSSD " "configuration." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:55 msgid "" "In the case where the UPN is not available in the identity backend, " "<command>sssd</command> will construct a UPN using the format " "<replaceable>username</replaceable>@<replaceable>krb5_realm</replaceable>." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:77 msgid "" "Specifies the comma-separated list of IP addresses or hostnames of the " "Kerberos servers to which SSSD should connect, in the order of preference. " "For more information on failover and server redundancy, see the " "<quote>FAILOVER</quote> section. An optional port number (preceded by a " "colon) may be appended to the addresses or hostnames. If empty, service " "discovery is enabled; for more information, refer to the <quote>SERVICE " "DISCOVERY</quote> section." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:106 msgid "" "The name of the Kerberos realm. This option is required and must be " "specified." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:113 msgid "krb5_kpasswd, krb5_backup_kpasswd (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:116 msgid "" "If the change password service is not running on the KDC, alternative " "servers can be defined here. An optional port number (preceded by a colon) " "may be appended to the addresses or hostnames." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:122 msgid "" "For more information on failover and server redundancy, see the " "<quote>FAILOVER</quote> section. NOTE: Even if there are no more kpasswd " "servers to try, the backend is not switched to operate offline if " "authentication against the KDC is still possible." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:129 msgid "Default: Use the KDC" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:135 msgid "krb5_ccachedir (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:138 msgid "" "Directory to store credential caches. All the substitution sequences of " "krb5_ccname_template can be used here, too, except %d and %P. The directory " "is created as private and owned by the user, with permissions set to 0700." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:145 msgid "Default: /tmp" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:151 msgid "krb5_ccname_template (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:165 include/override_homedir.xml:11 msgid "%u" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:166 include/override_homedir.xml:12 msgid "login name" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:169 include/override_homedir.xml:15 msgid "%U" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:170 msgid "login UID" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:173 msgid "%p" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:174 msgid "principal name" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:178 msgid "%r" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:179 msgid "realm name" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:182 msgid "%h" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:183 sssd-ifp.5.xml:108 msgid "home directory" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:187 include/override_homedir.xml:19 msgid "%d" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:188 msgid "value of krb5_ccachedir" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:193 include/override_homedir.xml:27 msgid "%P" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:194 msgid "the process ID of the SSSD client" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:199 include/override_homedir.xml:45 msgid "%%" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:200 include/override_homedir.xml:46 msgid "a literal '%'" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:154 msgid "" "Location of the user's credential cache. Three credential cache types are " "currently supported: <quote>FILE</quote>, <quote>DIR</quote> and " "<quote>KEYRING:persistent</quote>. The cache can be specified either as " "<replaceable>TYPE:RESIDUAL</replaceable>, or as an absolute path, which " "implies the <quote>FILE</quote> type. In the template, the following " "sequences are substituted: <placeholder type=\"variablelist\" id=\"0\"/> If " "the template ends with 'XXXXXX' mkstemp(3) is used to create a unique " "filename in a safe way." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:208 msgid "" "When using KEYRING types, the only supported mechanism is <quote>KEYRING:" "persistent:%U</quote>, which uses the Linux kernel keyring to store " "credentials on a per-UID basis. This is also the recommended choice, as it " "is the most secure and predictable method." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:216 msgid "" "The default value for the credential cache name is sourced from the profile " "stored in the system wide krb5.conf configuration file in the [libdefaults] " "section. The option name is default_ccache_name. See krb5.conf(5)'s " "PARAMETER EXPANSION paragraph for additional information on the expansion " "format defined by krb5.conf." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:225 msgid "Default: (from libkrb5)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:231 msgid "krb5_auth_timeout (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:234 msgid "" "Timeout in seconds after an online authentication request or change password " "request is aborted. If possible, the authentication request is continued " "offline." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:248 msgid "" "Verify with the help of krb5_keytab that the TGT obtained has not been " "spoofed. The keytab is checked for entries sequentially, and the first entry " "with a matching realm is used for validation. If no entry matches the realm, " "the last entry in the keytab is used. This process can be used to validate " "environments using cross-realm trust by placing the appropriate keytab entry " "as the last entry or the only entry in the keytab file." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:263 msgid "krb5_keytab (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:266 msgid "" "The location of the keytab to use when validating credentials obtained from " "KDCs." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:270 msgid "Default: /etc/krb5.keytab" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:276 msgid "krb5_store_password_if_offline (boolean)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:279 msgid "" "Store the password of the user if the provider is offline and use it to " "request a TGT when the provider comes online again." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:284 msgid "" "NOTE: this feature is only available on Linux. Passwords stored in this way " "are kept in plaintext in the kernel keyring and are potentially accessible " "by the root user (with difficulty)." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:297 msgid "krb5_renewable_lifetime (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:300 msgid "" "Request a renewable ticket with a total lifetime, given as an integer " "immediately followed by a time unit:" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:305 sssd-krb5.5.xml:339 sssd-krb5.5.xml:376 msgid "<emphasis>s</emphasis> for seconds" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:308 sssd-krb5.5.xml:342 sssd-krb5.5.xml:379 msgid "<emphasis>m</emphasis> for minutes" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:311 sssd-krb5.5.xml:345 sssd-krb5.5.xml:382 msgid "<emphasis>h</emphasis> for hours" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:314 sssd-krb5.5.xml:348 sssd-krb5.5.xml:385 msgid "<emphasis>d</emphasis> for days." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:317 sssd-krb5.5.xml:388 msgid "If there is no unit given, <emphasis>s</emphasis> is assumed." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:321 sssd-krb5.5.xml:392 msgid "" "NOTE: It is not possible to mix units. To set the renewable lifetime to one " "and a half hours, use '90m' instead of '1h30m'." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:326 msgid "Default: not set, i.e. the TGT is not renewable" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:332 msgid "krb5_lifetime (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:335 msgid "" "Request ticket with a lifetime, given as an integer immediately followed by " "a time unit:" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:351 msgid "If there is no unit given <emphasis>s</emphasis> is assumed." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:355 msgid "" "NOTE: It is not possible to mix units. To set the lifetime to one and a " "half hours please use '90m' instead of '1h30m'." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:360 msgid "" "Default: not set, i.e. the default ticket lifetime configured on the KDC." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:367 msgid "krb5_renew_interval (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:370 msgid "" "The time in seconds between two checks if the TGT should be renewed. TGTs " "are renewed if about half of their lifetime is exceeded, given as an integer " "immediately followed by a time unit:" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:397 msgid "If this option is not set or is 0 the automatic renewal is disabled." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:415 msgid "" "<emphasis>never</emphasis> use FAST. This is equivalent to not setting this " "option at all." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:419 msgid "" "<emphasis>try</emphasis> to use FAST. If the server does not support FAST, " "continue the authentication without it." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:429 msgid "Default: not set, i.e. FAST is not used." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:432 msgid "NOTE: a keytab is required to use FAST." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:444 msgid "krb5_fast_principal (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:447 msgid "Specifies the server principal to use for FAST." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:456 msgid "" "Specifies if the host and user principal should be canonicalized. This " "feature is available with MIT Kerberos 1.7 and later versions." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:505 msgid "Default: false (AD provider: true)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:65 msgid "" "If the auth-module krb5 is used in an SSSD domain, the following options " "must be used. See the <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sssd.conf</" "refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </citerefentry> manual page, section " "<quote>DOMAIN SECTIONS</quote>, for details on the configuration of an SSSD " "domain. <placeholder type=\"variablelist\" id=\"0\"/>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:521 msgid "" "The following example assumes that SSSD is correctly configured and FOO is " "one of the domains in the <replaceable>[sssd]</replaceable> section. This " "example shows only configuration of Kerberos authentication; it does not " "include any identity provider." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><programlisting> #: sssd-krb5.5.xml:529 #, no-wrap msgid "" " [domain/FOO]\n" " auth_provider = krb5\n" " krb5_server = 192.168.1.1\n" " krb5_realm = EXAMPLE.COM\n" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refname> #: sss_groupadd.8.xml:10 sss_groupadd.8.xml:15 msgid "sss_groupadd" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refpurpose> #: sss_groupadd.8.xml:16 msgid "create a new group" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsynopsisdiv><cmdsynopsis> #: sss_groupadd.8.xml:21 msgid "" "<command>sss_groupadd</command> <arg choice='opt'> <replaceable>options</" "replaceable> </arg> <arg choice='plain'><replaceable>GROUP</replaceable></" "arg>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sss_groupadd.8.xml:32 msgid "" "<command>sss_groupadd</command> creates a new group. These groups are " "compatible with POSIX groups, with the additional feature that they can " "contain other groups as members." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sss_groupadd.8.xml:43 sss_seed.8.xml:88 msgid "" "<option>-g</option>,<option>--gid</option> <replaceable>GID</replaceable>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_groupadd.8.xml:48 msgid "" "Set the GID of the group to the value of <replaceable>GID</replaceable>. If " "not given, it is chosen automatically." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refname> #: sss_userdel.8.xml:10 sss_userdel.8.xml:15 msgid "sss_userdel" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refpurpose> #: sss_userdel.8.xml:16 msgid "delete a user account" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsynopsisdiv><cmdsynopsis> #: sss_userdel.8.xml:21 msgid "" "<command>sss_userdel</command> <arg choice='opt'> <replaceable>options</" "replaceable> </arg> <arg choice='plain'><replaceable>LOGIN</replaceable></" "arg>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sss_userdel.8.xml:32 msgid "" "<command>sss_userdel</command> deletes a user identified by login name " "<replaceable>LOGIN</replaceable> from the system." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sss_userdel.8.xml:44 msgid "<option>-r</option>,<option>--remove</option>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_userdel.8.xml:48 msgid "" "Files in the user's home directory will be removed along with the home " "directory itself and the user's mail spool. Overrides the configuration." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sss_userdel.8.xml:56 msgid "<option>-R</option>,<option>--no-remove</option>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_userdel.8.xml:60 msgid "" "Files in the user's home directory will NOT be removed along with the home " "directory itself and the user's mail spool. Overrides the configuration." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sss_userdel.8.xml:68 msgid "<option>-f</option>,<option>--force</option>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_userdel.8.xml:72 msgid "" "This option forces <command>sss_userdel</command> to remove the user's home " "directory and mail spool, even if they are not owned by the specified user." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sss_userdel.8.xml:80 msgid "<option>-k</option>,<option>--kick</option>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_userdel.8.xml:84 msgid "Before actually deleting the user, terminate all his processes." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refname> #: sss_groupdel.8.xml:10 sss_groupdel.8.xml:15 msgid "sss_groupdel" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refpurpose> #: sss_groupdel.8.xml:16 msgid "delete a group" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsynopsisdiv><cmdsynopsis> #: sss_groupdel.8.xml:21 msgid "" "<command>sss_groupdel</command> <arg choice='opt'> <replaceable>options</" "replaceable> </arg> <arg choice='plain'><replaceable>GROUP</replaceable></" "arg>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sss_groupdel.8.xml:32 msgid "" "<command>sss_groupdel</command> deletes a group identified by its name " "<replaceable>GROUP</replaceable> from the system." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refname> #: sss_groupshow.8.xml:10 sss_groupshow.8.xml:15 msgid "sss_groupshow" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refpurpose> #: sss_groupshow.8.xml:16 msgid "print properties of a group" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsynopsisdiv><cmdsynopsis> #: sss_groupshow.8.xml:21 msgid "" "<command>sss_groupshow</command> <arg choice='opt'> <replaceable>options</" "replaceable> </arg> <arg choice='plain'><replaceable>GROUP</replaceable></" "arg>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sss_groupshow.8.xml:32 msgid "" "<command>sss_groupshow</command> displays information about a group " "identified by its name <replaceable>GROUP</replaceable>. The information " "includes the group ID number, members of the group and the parent group." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sss_groupshow.8.xml:43 msgid "<option>-R</option>,<option>--recursive</option>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_groupshow.8.xml:47 msgid "" "Also print indirect group members in a tree-like hierarchy. Note that this " "also affects printing parent groups - without <option>R</option>, only the " "direct parent will be printed." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refname> #: sss_usermod.8.xml:10 sss_usermod.8.xml:15 msgid "sss_usermod" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refpurpose> #: sss_usermod.8.xml:16 msgid "modify a user account" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsynopsisdiv><cmdsynopsis> #: sss_usermod.8.xml:21 msgid "" "<command>sss_usermod</command> <arg choice='opt'> <replaceable>options</" "replaceable> </arg> <arg choice='plain'><replaceable>LOGIN</replaceable></" "arg>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sss_usermod.8.xml:32 msgid "" "<command>sss_usermod</command> modifies the account specified by " "<replaceable>LOGIN</replaceable> to reflect the changes that are specified " "on the command line." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_usermod.8.xml:60 msgid "The home directory of the user account." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_usermod.8.xml:71 msgid "The user's login shell." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_usermod.8.xml:82 msgid "" "Append this user to groups specified by the <replaceable>GROUPS</" "replaceable> parameter. The <replaceable>GROUPS</replaceable> parameter is " "a comma separated list of group names." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_usermod.8.xml:96 msgid "" "Remove this user from groups specified by the <replaceable>GROUPS</" "replaceable> parameter." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sss_usermod.8.xml:103 msgid "<option>-l</option>,<option>--lock</option>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_usermod.8.xml:107 msgid "Lock the user account. The user won't be able to log in." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sss_usermod.8.xml:114 msgid "<option>-u</option>,<option>--unlock</option>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_usermod.8.xml:118 msgid "Unlock the user account." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_usermod.8.xml:129 msgid "The SELinux user for the user's login." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sss_usermod.8.xml:135 msgid "<option>--addattr</option> <replaceable>ATTR_NAME_VAL</replaceable>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_usermod.8.xml:140 msgid "Add an attribute/value pair. The format is attrname=value." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sss_usermod.8.xml:147 msgid "<option>--setattr</option> <replaceable>ATTR_NAME_VAL</replaceable>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_usermod.8.xml:152 msgid "" "Set an attribute to a name/value pair. The format is attrname=value. For " "multi-valued attributes, the command replaces the values already present" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sss_usermod.8.xml:160 msgid "<option>--delattr</option> <replaceable>ATTR_NAME_VAL</replaceable>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_usermod.8.xml:165 msgid "Delete an attribute/value pair. The format is attrname=value." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refname> #: sss_cache.8.xml:10 sss_cache.8.xml:15 msgid "sss_cache" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refpurpose> #: sss_cache.8.xml:16 msgid "perform cache cleanup" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsynopsisdiv><cmdsynopsis> #: sss_cache.8.xml:21 msgid "" "<command>sss_cache</command> <arg choice='opt'> <replaceable>options</" "replaceable> </arg>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sss_cache.8.xml:31 msgid "" "<command>sss_cache</command> invalidates records in SSSD cache. Invalidated " "records are forced to be reloaded from server as soon as related SSSD " "backend is online." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sss_cache.8.xml:42 msgid "<option>-E</option>,<option>--everything</option>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_cache.8.xml:46 msgid "Invalidate all cached entries except for sudo rules." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sss_cache.8.xml:52 msgid "" "<option>-u</option>,<option>--user</option> <replaceable>login</replaceable>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_cache.8.xml:57 msgid "Invalidate specific user." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sss_cache.8.xml:63 msgid "<option>-U</option>,<option>--users</option>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_cache.8.xml:67 msgid "" "Invalidate all user records. This option overrides invalidation of specific " "user if it was also set." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sss_cache.8.xml:74 msgid "" "<option>-g</option>,<option>--group</option> <replaceable>group</replaceable>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_cache.8.xml:79 msgid "Invalidate specific group." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sss_cache.8.xml:85 msgid "<option>-G</option>,<option>--groups</option>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_cache.8.xml:89 msgid "" "Invalidate all group records. This option overrides invalidation of specific " "group if it was also set." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sss_cache.8.xml:96 msgid "" "<option>-n</option>,<option>--netgroup</option> <replaceable>netgroup</" "replaceable>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_cache.8.xml:101 msgid "Invalidate specific netgroup." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sss_cache.8.xml:107 msgid "<option>-N</option>,<option>--netgroups</option>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_cache.8.xml:111 msgid "" "Invalidate all netgroup records. This option overrides invalidation of " "specific netgroup if it was also set." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sss_cache.8.xml:118 msgid "" "<option>-s</option>,<option>--service</option> <replaceable>service</" "replaceable>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_cache.8.xml:123 msgid "Invalidate specific service." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sss_cache.8.xml:129 msgid "<option>-S</option>,<option>--services</option>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_cache.8.xml:133 msgid "" "Invalidate all service records. This option overrides invalidation of " "specific service if it was also set." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sss_cache.8.xml:140 msgid "" "<option>-a</option>,<option>--autofs-map</option> <replaceable>autofs-map</" "replaceable>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_cache.8.xml:145 msgid "Invalidate specific autofs maps." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sss_cache.8.xml:151 msgid "<option>-A</option>,<option>--autofs-maps</option>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_cache.8.xml:155 msgid "" "Invalidate all autofs maps. This option overrides invalidation of specific " "map if it was also set." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sss_cache.8.xml:162 #, fuzzy #| msgid "" #| "<option>-a</option>,<option>--append-group</option> <replaceable>GROUPS</" #| "replaceable>" msgid "" "<option>-h</option>,<option>--ssh-host</option> <replaceable>hostname</" "replaceable>" msgstr "" "<option>-a</option>,<option>--append-group</option> <replaceable>GROEPEN</" "replaceable>" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_cache.8.xml:167 msgid "Invalidate SSH public keys of a specific host." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sss_cache.8.xml:173 #, fuzzy #| msgid "" #| "<option>-a</option>,<option>--append-group</option> <replaceable>GROUPS</" #| "replaceable>" msgid "<option>-H</option>,<option>--ssh-hosts</option>" msgstr "" "<option>-a</option>,<option>--append-group</option> <replaceable>GROEPEN</" "replaceable>" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_cache.8.xml:177 msgid "" "Invalidate SSH public keys of all hosts. This option overrides invalidation " "of SSH public keys of specific host if it was also set." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sss_cache.8.xml:185 msgid "" "<option>-d</option>,<option>--domain</option> <replaceable>domain</" "replaceable>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_cache.8.xml:190 msgid "Restrict invalidation process only to a particular domain." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refname> #: sss_debuglevel.8.xml:10 sss_debuglevel.8.xml:15 msgid "sss_debuglevel" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refpurpose> #: sss_debuglevel.8.xml:16 msgid "change debug level while SSSD is running" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsynopsisdiv><cmdsynopsis> #: sss_debuglevel.8.xml:21 msgid "" "<command>sss_debuglevel</command> <arg choice='opt'> <replaceable>options</" "replaceable> </arg> <arg choice='plain'><replaceable>NEW_DEBUG_LEVEL</" "replaceable></arg>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sss_debuglevel.8.xml:32 msgid "" "<command>sss_debuglevel</command> changes debug level of SSSD monitor and " "providers to <replaceable>NEW_DEBUG_LEVEL</replaceable> while SSSD is " "running." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sss_debuglevel.8.xml:59 msgid "<replaceable>NEW_DEBUG_LEVEL</replaceable>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refname> #: sss_seed.8.xml:10 sss_seed.8.xml:15 msgid "sss_seed" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refpurpose> #: sss_seed.8.xml:16 msgid "seed the SSSD cache with a user" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsynopsisdiv><cmdsynopsis> #: sss_seed.8.xml:21 msgid "" "<command>sss_seed</command> <arg choice='opt'> <replaceable>options</" "replaceable> </arg> <arg choice='plain'>-D <replaceable>DOMAIN</" "replaceable></arg> <arg choice='plain'>-n <replaceable>USER</replaceable></" "arg>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sss_seed.8.xml:33 msgid "" "<command>sss_seed</command> seeds the SSSD cache with a user entry and " "temporary password. If a user entry is already present in the SSSD cache " "then the entry is updated with the temporary password." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sss_seed.8.xml:46 msgid "" "<option>-D</option>,<option>--domain</option> <replaceable>DOMAIN</" "replaceable>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_seed.8.xml:51 msgid "" "Provide the name of the domain in which the user is a member of. The domain " "is also used to retrieve user information. The domain must be configured in " "sssd.conf. The <replaceable>DOMAIN</replaceable> option must be provided. " "Information retrieved from the domain overrides what is provided in the " "options." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sss_seed.8.xml:63 msgid "" "<option>-n</option>,<option>--username</option> <replaceable>USER</" "replaceable>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_seed.8.xml:68 msgid "" "The username of the entry to be created or modified in the cache. The " "<replaceable>USER</replaceable> option must be provided." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_seed.8.xml:81 msgid "Set the UID of the user to <replaceable>UID</replaceable>." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_seed.8.xml:93 msgid "Set the GID of the user to <replaceable>GID</replaceable>." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_seed.8.xml:117 msgid "" "Set the home directory of the user to <replaceable>HOME_DIR</replaceable>." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_seed.8.xml:129 msgid "Set the login shell of the user to <replaceable>SHELL</replaceable>." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_seed.8.xml:140 msgid "" "Interactive mode for entering user information. This option will only prompt " "for information not provided in the options or retrieved from the domain." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sss_seed.8.xml:148 msgid "" "<option>-p</option>,<option>--password-file</option> <replaceable>PASS_FILE</" "replaceable>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_seed.8.xml:153 msgid "" "Specify file to read user's password from. (if not specified password is " "prompted for)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sss_seed.8.xml:165 msgid "" "The length of the password (or the size of file specified with -p or --" "password-file option) must be less than or equal to PASS_MAX bytes (64 bytes " "on systems with no globally-defined PASS_MAX value)." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refname> #: sssd-ifp.5.xml:10 sssd-ifp.5.xml:16 msgid "sssd-ifp" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refpurpose> #: sssd-ifp.5.xml:17 msgid "SSSD InfoPipe responder" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-ifp.5.xml:23 msgid "" "This manual page describes the configuration of the InfoPipe responder for " "<citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sssd</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>8</manvolnum> " "</citerefentry>. For a detailed syntax reference, refer to the <quote>FILE " "FORMAT</quote> section of the <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sssd.conf</" "refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </citerefentry> manual page." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-ifp.5.xml:36 msgid "" "The InfoPipe responder provides a public D-Bus interface accessible over the " "system bus. The interface allows the user to query information about remote " "users and groups over the system bus." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sssd-ifp.5.xml:46 msgid "These options can be used to configure the InfoPipe responder." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ifp.5.xml:53 msgid "" "Specifies the comma-separated list of UID values or user names that are " "allowed to access the InfoPipe responder. User names are resolved to UIDs at " "startup." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ifp.5.xml:59 msgid "" "Default: 0 (only the root user is allowed to access the InfoPipe responder)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ifp.5.xml:63 msgid "" "Please note that although the UID 0 is used as the default it will be " "overwritten with this option. If you still want to allow the root user to " "access the InfoPipe responder, which would be the typical case, you have to " "add 0 to the list of allowed UIDs as well." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ifp.5.xml:74 msgid "user_attributes (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ifp.5.xml:77 msgid "Specifies the comma-separated list of white or blacklisted attributes." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ifp.5.xml:91 msgid "name" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ifp.5.xml:92 msgid "user's login name" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ifp.5.xml:95 msgid "uidNumber" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ifp.5.xml:96 msgid "user ID" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ifp.5.xml:99 msgid "gidNumber" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ifp.5.xml:100 msgid "primary group ID" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ifp.5.xml:103 msgid "gecos" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ifp.5.xml:104 msgid "user information, typically full name" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ifp.5.xml:107 msgid "homeDirectory" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sssd-ifp.5.xml:111 msgid "loginShell" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ifp.5.xml:112 msgid "user shell" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ifp.5.xml:81 msgid "" "By default, the InfoPipe responder only allows the default set of POSIX " "attributes to be requested. This set is the same as returned by " "<citerefentry> <refentrytitle>getpwnam</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>3</" "manvolnum> </citerefentry> and includes: <placeholder type=\"variablelist\" " "id=\"0\"/>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para><programlisting> #: sssd-ifp.5.xml:125 #, no-wrap msgid "" "user_attributes = +telephoneNumber, -loginShell\n" " " msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ifp.5.xml:117 msgid "" "It is possible to add another attribute to this set by using <quote>" "+attr_name</quote> or explicitly remove an attribute using <quote>-" "attr_name</quote>. For example, to allow <quote>telephoneNumber</quote> but " "deny <quote>loginShell</quote>, you would use the following configuration: " "<placeholder type=\"programlisting\" id=\"0\"/>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sssd-ifp.5.xml:129 msgid "Default: not set. Only the default set of POSIX attributes is allowed." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refentryinfo> #: sss_rpcidmapd.5.xml:8 msgid "" "<productname>sss rpc.idmapd plugin</productname> <author> <firstname>Noam</" "firstname> <surname>Meltzer</surname> <affiliation> <orgname>Primary Data " "Inc.</orgname> </affiliation> <contrib>Developer (2013-2014)</contrib> </" "author> <author> <firstname>Noam</firstname> <surname>Meltzer</surname> " "<contrib>Developer (2014-)</contrib> <email>tsnoam@gmail.com</email> </" "author>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refname> #: sss_rpcidmapd.5.xml:26 sss_rpcidmapd.5.xml:32 #, fuzzy #| msgid "sss_groupmod" msgid "sss_rpcidmapd" msgstr "sss_groupmod" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refpurpose> #: sss_rpcidmapd.5.xml:33 msgid "sss plugin configuration directives for rpc.idmapd" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><title> #: sss_rpcidmapd.5.xml:37 msgid "CONFIGURATION FILE" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sss_rpcidmapd.5.xml:39 msgid "" "rpc.idmapd configuration file is usually found at <emphasis>/etc/idmapd." "conf</emphasis>. See <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>idmapd.conf</" "refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </citerefentry> for more information." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><title> #: sss_rpcidmapd.5.xml:49 msgid "SSS CONFIGURATION EXTENSION" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><title> #: sss_rpcidmapd.5.xml:51 msgid "Enable SSS plugin" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para> #: sss_rpcidmapd.5.xml:53 msgid "" "In section <quote>[Translation]</quote>, modify/set <quote>Method</quote> " "attribute to contain <emphasis>sss</emphasis>." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><title> #: sss_rpcidmapd.5.xml:59 #, fuzzy #| msgid "The [sssd] section" msgid "[sss] config section" msgstr "De [sssd] sectie" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><para> #: sss_rpcidmapd.5.xml:61 msgid "" "In order to change the default of one of the configuration attributes of the " "<emphasis>sss</emphasis> plugin listed below you will need to create a " "config section for it, named <quote>[sss]</quote>." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><title> #: sss_rpcidmapd.5.xml:67 #, fuzzy #| msgid "NSS configuration options" msgid "Configuration attributes" msgstr "NSS configuratie-opties" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sss_rpcidmapd.5.xml:69 msgid "memcache (bool)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><refsect2><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_rpcidmapd.5.xml:72 msgid "Indicates whether or not to use memcache optimisation technique." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><title> #: sss_rpcidmapd.5.xml:85 msgid "SSSD INTEGRATION" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sss_rpcidmapd.5.xml:87 msgid "" "The sss plugin requires the <emphasis>NSS Responder</emphasis> to be enabled " "in sssd." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sss_rpcidmapd.5.xml:91 msgid "" "The attribute <quote>use_fully_qualified_names</quote> must be enabled on " "all domains (NFSv4 clients expect a fully qualified name to be sent on the " "wire)." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><programlisting> #: sss_rpcidmapd.5.xml:103 #, no-wrap msgid "" "[General]\n" "Verbosity = 2\n" "# domain must be synced between NFSv4 server and clients\n" "# Solaris/Illumos/AIX use \"localdomain\" as default!\n" "Domain = default\n" "\n" "[Mapping]\n" "Nobody-User = nfsnobody\n" "Nobody-Group = nfsnobody\n" "\n" "[Translation]\n" "Method = sss\n" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sss_rpcidmapd.5.xml:100 msgid "" "The following example shows a minimal idmapd.conf which makes use of the sss " "plugin. <placeholder type=\"programlisting\" id=\"0\"/>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><title> #: sss_rpcidmapd.5.xml:120 include/seealso.xml:2 msgid "SEE ALSO" msgstr "ZIE OOK" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sss_rpcidmapd.5.xml:122 msgid "" "<citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sssd</refentrytitle><manvolnum>8</manvolnum> </" "citerefentry>, <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>idmapd.conf</refentrytitle> " "<manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </citerefentry>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refname> #: sss_ssh_authorizedkeys.1.xml:10 sss_ssh_authorizedkeys.1.xml:15 msgid "sss_ssh_authorizedkeys" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refmeta><manvolnum> #: sss_ssh_authorizedkeys.1.xml:11 sss_ssh_knownhostsproxy.1.xml:11 msgid "1" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refpurpose> #: sss_ssh_authorizedkeys.1.xml:16 msgid "get OpenSSH authorized keys" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsynopsisdiv><cmdsynopsis> #: sss_ssh_authorizedkeys.1.xml:21 msgid "" "<command>sss_ssh_authorizedkeys</command> <arg choice='opt'> " "<replaceable>options</replaceable> </arg> <arg " "choice='plain'><replaceable>USER</replaceable></arg>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sss_ssh_authorizedkeys.1.xml:32 msgid "" "<command>sss_ssh_authorizedkeys</command> acquires SSH public keys for user " "<replaceable>USER</replaceable> and outputs them in OpenSSH authorized_keys " "format (see the <quote>AUTHORIZED_KEYS FILE FORMAT</quote> section of " "<citerefentry><refentrytitle>sshd</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></" "citerefentry> for more information)." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sss_ssh_authorizedkeys.1.xml:41 msgid "" "<citerefentry><refentrytitle>sshd</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></" "citerefentry> can be configured to use <command>sss_ssh_authorizedkeys</" "command> for public key user authentication if it is compiled with support " "for either <quote>AuthorizedKeysCommand</quote> or <quote>PubkeyAgent</" "quote> <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sshd_config</refentrytitle> " "<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> options." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><programlisting> #: sss_ssh_authorizedkeys.1.xml:58 #, no-wrap msgid "AuthorizedKeysCommand /usr/bin/sss_ssh_authorizedkeys\n" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sss_ssh_authorizedkeys.1.xml:51 msgid "" "If <quote>AuthorizedKeysCommand</quote> is supported, " "<citerefentry><refentrytitle>sshd</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></" "citerefentry> can be configured to use it by putting the following directive " "in <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sshd_config</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</" "manvolnum></citerefentry>: <placeholder type=\"programlisting\" id=\"0\"/>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><programlisting> #: sss_ssh_authorizedkeys.1.xml:69 #, no-wrap msgid "PubKeyAgent /usr/bin/sss_ssh_authorizedkeys %u\n" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sss_ssh_authorizedkeys.1.xml:62 msgid "" "If <quote>PubkeyAgent</quote> is supported, " "<citerefentry><refentrytitle>sshd</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></" "citerefentry> can be configured to use it by using the following directive " "for <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sshd</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>8</" "manvolnum></citerefentry> configuration: <placeholder type=\"programlisting" "\" id=\"0\"/>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_ssh_authorizedkeys.1.xml:84 msgid "" "Search for user public keys in SSSD domain <replaceable>DOMAIN</replaceable>." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><title> #: sss_ssh_authorizedkeys.1.xml:93 sss_ssh_knownhostsproxy.1.xml:92 msgid "EXIT STATUS" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sss_ssh_authorizedkeys.1.xml:95 sss_ssh_knownhostsproxy.1.xml:94 msgid "" "In case of success, an exit value of 0 is returned. Otherwise, 1 is returned." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refname> #: sss_ssh_knownhostsproxy.1.xml:10 sss_ssh_knownhostsproxy.1.xml:15 msgid "sss_ssh_knownhostsproxy" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refnamediv><refpurpose> #: sss_ssh_knownhostsproxy.1.xml:16 msgid "get OpenSSH host keys" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsynopsisdiv><cmdsynopsis> #: sss_ssh_knownhostsproxy.1.xml:21 msgid "" "<command>sss_ssh_knownhostsproxy</command> <arg choice='opt'> " "<replaceable>options</replaceable> </arg> <arg " "choice='plain'><replaceable>HOST</replaceable></arg> <arg " "choice='opt'><replaceable>PROXY_COMMAND</replaceable></arg>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sss_ssh_knownhostsproxy.1.xml:33 msgid "" "<command>sss_ssh_knownhostsproxy</command> acquires SSH host public keys for " "host <replaceable>HOST</replaceable>, stores them in a custom OpenSSH " "known_hosts file (see the <quote>SSH_KNOWN_HOSTS FILE FORMAT</quote> section " "of <citerefentry><refentrytitle>sshd</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>8</" "manvolnum></citerefentry> for more information) <filename>/var/lib/sss/" "pubconf/known_hosts</filename> and estabilishes connection to the host." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sss_ssh_knownhostsproxy.1.xml:43 msgid "" "If <replaceable>PROXY_COMMAND</replaceable> is specified, it is used to " "create the connection to the host instead of opening a socket." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para><programlisting> #: sss_ssh_knownhostsproxy.1.xml:55 #, no-wrap msgid "" "ProxyCommand /usr/bin/sss_ssh_knownhostsproxy -p %p %h\n" "GlobalKnownHostsFile /var/lib/sss/pubconf/known_hosts\n" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><para> #: sss_ssh_knownhostsproxy.1.xml:48 msgid "" "<citerefentry><refentrytitle>ssh</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></" "citerefentry> can be configured to use <command>sss_ssh_knownhostsproxy</" "command> for host key authentication by using the following directives for " "<citerefentry><refentrytitle>ssh</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></" "citerefentry> configuration: <placeholder type=\"programlisting\" id=\"0\"/>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: sss_ssh_knownhostsproxy.1.xml:66 msgid "" "<option>-p</option>,<option>--port</option> <replaceable>PORT</replaceable>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_ssh_knownhostsproxy.1.xml:71 msgid "" "Use port <replaceable>PORT</replaceable> to connect to the host. By " "default, port 22 is used." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <reference><refentry><refsect1><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: sss_ssh_knownhostsproxy.1.xml:83 msgid "" "Search for host public keys in SSSD domain <replaceable>DOMAIN</replaceable>." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><title> #: include/service_discovery.xml:2 msgid "SERVICE DISCOVERY" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><para> #: include/service_discovery.xml:4 msgid "" "The service discovery feature allows back ends to automatically find the " "appropriate servers to connect to using a special DNS query. This feature is " "not supported for backup servers." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><title> #: include/service_discovery.xml:9 include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:99 msgid "Configuration" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><para> #: include/service_discovery.xml:11 msgid "" "If no servers are specified, the back end automatically uses service " "discovery to try to find a server. Optionally, the user may choose to use " "both fixed server addresses and service discovery by inserting a special " "keyword, <quote>_srv_</quote>, in the list of servers. The order of " "preference is maintained. This feature is useful if, for example, the user " "prefers to use service discovery whenever possible, and fall back to a " "specific server when no servers can be discovered using DNS." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><title> #: include/service_discovery.xml:23 msgid "The domain name" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><para> #: include/service_discovery.xml:25 msgid "" "Please refer to the <quote>dns_discovery_domain</quote> parameter in the " "<citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sssd.conf</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</" "manvolnum> </citerefentry> manual page for more details." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><title> #: include/service_discovery.xml:35 msgid "The protocol" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><para> #: include/service_discovery.xml:37 msgid "" "The queries usually specify _tcp as the protocol. Exceptions are documented " "in respective option description." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><title> #: include/service_discovery.xml:42 msgid "See Also" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><para> #: include/service_discovery.xml:44 msgid "" "For more information on the service discovery mechanism, refer to RFC 2782." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: outside any tag (error?) #: include/upstream.xml:1 msgid "<placeholder type=\"refentryinfo\" id=\"0\"/>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><title> #: include/failover.xml:2 msgid "FAILOVER" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><para> #: include/failover.xml:4 msgid "" "The failover feature allows back ends to automatically switch to a different " "server if the current server fails." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><title> #: include/failover.xml:8 msgid "Failover Syntax" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><para> #: include/failover.xml:10 msgid "" "The list of servers is given as a comma-separated list; any number of spaces " "is allowed around the comma. The servers are listed in order of preference. " "The list can contain any number of servers." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><para> #: include/failover.xml:16 msgid "" "For each failover-enabled config option, two variants exist: " "<emphasis>primary</emphasis> and <emphasis>backup</emphasis>. The idea is " "that servers in the primary list are preferred and backup servers are only " "searched if no primary servers can be reached. If a backup server is " "selected, a timeout of 31 seconds is set. After this timeout SSSD will " "periodically try to reconnect to one of the primary servers. If it succeeds, " "it will replace the current active (backup) server." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><title> #: include/failover.xml:27 msgid "The Failover Mechanism" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><para> #: include/failover.xml:29 msgid "" "The failover mechanism distinguishes between a machine and a service. The " "back end first tries to resolve the hostname of a given machine; if this " "resolution attempt fails, the machine is considered offline. No further " "attempts are made to connect to this machine for any other service. If the " "resolution attempt succeeds, the back end tries to connect to a service on " "this machine. If the service connection attempt fails, then only this " "particular service is considered offline and the back end automatically " "switches over to the next service. The machine is still considered online " "and might still be tried for another service." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><para> #: include/failover.xml:42 msgid "" "Further connection attempts are made to machines or services marked as " "offline after a specified period of time; this is currently hard coded to 30 " "seconds." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><para> #: include/failover.xml:47 msgid "" "If there are no more machines to try, the back end as a whole switches to " "offline mode, and then attempts to reconnect every 30 seconds." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><title> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:2 msgid "ID MAPPING" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><para> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:4 msgid "" "The ID-mapping feature allows SSSD to act as a client of Active Directory " "without requiring administrators to extend user attributes to support POSIX " "attributes for user and group identifiers." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><para> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:9 msgid "" "NOTE: When ID-mapping is enabled, the uidNumber and gidNumber attributes are " "ignored. This is to avoid the possibility of conflicts between automatically-" "assigned and manually-assigned values. If you need to use manually-assigned " "values, ALL values must be manually-assigned." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><para> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:16 msgid "" "Please note that changing the ID mapping related configuration options will " "cause user and group IDs to change. At the moment, SSSD does not support " "changing IDs, so the SSSD database must be removed. Because cached passwords " "are also stored in the database, removing the database should only be " "performed while the authentication servers are reachable, otherwise users " "might get locked out. In order to cache the password, an authentication must " "be performed. It is not sufficient to use <citerefentry> " "<refentrytitle>sss_cache</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>8</manvolnum> </" "citerefentry> to remove the database, rather the process consists of:" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:33 msgid "Making sure the remote servers are reachable" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:38 msgid "Stopping the SSSD service" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:43 msgid "Removing the database" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:48 msgid "Starting the SSSD service" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><para> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:52 msgid "" "Moreover, as the change of IDs might necessitate the adjustment of other " "system properties such as file and directory ownership, it's advisable to " "plan ahead and test the ID mapping configuration thoroughly." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><title> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:59 msgid "Mapping Algorithm" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><para> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:61 msgid "" "Active Directory provides an objectSID for every user and group object in " "the directory. This objectSID can be broken up into components that " "represent the Active Directory domain identity and the relative identifier " "(RID) of the user or group object." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><para> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:67 msgid "" "The SSSD ID-mapping algorithm takes a range of available UIDs and divides it " "into equally-sized component sections - called \"slices\"-. Each slice " "represents the space available to an Active Directory domain." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><para> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:73 msgid "" "When a user or group entry for a particular domain is encountered for the " "first time, the SSSD allocates one of the available slices for that domain. " "In order to make this slice-assignment repeatable on different client " "machines, we select the slice based on the following algorithm:" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><para> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:80 msgid "" "The SID string is passed through the murmurhash3 algorithm to convert it to " "a 32-bit hashed value. We then take the modulus of this value with the total " "number of available slices to pick the slice." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><para> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:86 msgid "" "NOTE: It is possible to encounter collisions in the hash and subsequent " "modulus. In these situations, we will select the next available slice, but " "it may not be possible to reproduce the same exact set of slices on other " "machines (since the order that they are encountered will determine their " "slice). In this situation, it is recommended to either switch to using " "explicit POSIX attributes in Active Directory (disabling ID-mapping) or " "configure a default domain to guarantee that at least one is always " "consistent. See <quote>Configuration</quote> for details." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><para> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:101 msgid "" "Minimum configuration (in the <quote>[domain/DOMAINNAME]</quote> section):" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><para><programlisting> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:106 #, no-wrap msgid "" "ldap_id_mapping = True\n" "ldap_schema = ad\n" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><para> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:111 msgid "" "The default configuration results in configuring 10,000 slices, each capable " "of holding up to 200,000 IDs, starting from 10,001 and going up to " "2,000,100,000. This should be sufficient for most deployments." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><refsect3><title> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:117 msgid "Advanced Configuration" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><refsect3><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:120 msgid "ldap_idmap_range_min (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><refsect3><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:123 msgid "" "Specifies the lower bound of the range of POSIX IDs to use for mapping " "Active Directory user and group SIDs." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><refsect3><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:127 msgid "" "NOTE: This option is different from <quote>min_id</quote> in that " "<quote>min_id</quote> acts to filter the output of requests to this domain, " "whereas this option controls the range of ID assignment. This is a subtle " "distinction, but the good general advice would be to have <quote>min_id</" "quote> be less-than or equal to <quote>ldap_idmap_range_min</quote>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><refsect3><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:137 include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:189 msgid "Default: 200000" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><refsect3><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:142 msgid "ldap_idmap_range_max (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><refsect3><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:145 msgid "" "Specifies the upper bound of the range of POSIX IDs to use for mapping " "Active Directory user and group SIDs." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><refsect3><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:149 msgid "" "NOTE: This option is different from <quote>max_id</quote> in that " "<quote>max_id</quote> acts to filter the output of requests to this domain, " "whereas this option controls the range of ID assignment. This is a subtle " "distinction, but the good general advice would be to have <quote>max_id</" "quote> be greater-than or equal to <quote>ldap_idmap_range_max</quote>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><refsect3><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:159 msgid "Default: 2000200000" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><refsect3><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:164 msgid "ldap_idmap_range_size (integer)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><refsect3><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:167 msgid "" "Specifies the number of IDs available for each slice. If the range size " "does not divide evenly into the min and max values, it will create as many " "complete slices as it can." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><refsect3><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:173 msgid "" "NOTE: The value of this option must be at least as large as the highest user " "RID planned for use on the Active Directory server. User lookups and login " "will fail for any user whose RID is greater than this value." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><refsect3><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:179 msgid "" "For example, if your most recently-added Active Directory user has " "objectSid=S-1-5-21-2153326666-2176343378-3404031434-1107, " "<quote>ldap_idmap_range_size</quote> must be at least 1107." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><refsect3><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:184 msgid "" "It is important to plan ahead for future expansion, as changing this value " "will result in changing all of the ID mappings on the system, leading to " "users with different local IDs than they previously had." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><refsect3><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:194 msgid "ldap_idmap_default_domain_sid (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><refsect3><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:197 msgid "" "Specify the domain SID of the default domain. This will guarantee that this " "domain will always be assigned to slice zero in the ID map, bypassing the " "murmurhash algorithm described above." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><refsect3><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:208 msgid "ldap_idmap_default_domain (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><refsect3><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:211 msgid "Specify the name of the default domain." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><refsect3><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:219 msgid "ldap_idmap_autorid_compat (boolean)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><refsect3><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:222 msgid "" "Changes the behavior of the ID-mapping algorithm to behave more similarly to " "winbind's <quote>idmap_autorid</quote> algorithm." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><refsect3><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:227 msgid "" "When this option is configured, domains will be allocated starting with " "slice zero and increasing monatomically with each additional domain." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><refsect3><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:232 msgid "" "NOTE: This algorithm is non-deterministic (it depends on the order that " "users and groups are requested). If this mode is required for compatibility " "with machines running winbind, it is recommended to also use the " "<quote>ldap_idmap_default_domain_sid</quote> option to guarantee that at " "least one domain is consistently allocated to slice zero." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><title> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:251 msgid "Well-Known SIDs" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><para> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:253 msgid "" "SSSD supports to look up the names of Well-Known SIDs, i.e. SIDs with a " "special hardcoded meaning. Since the generic users and groups related to " "those Well-Known SIDs have no equivalent in a Linux/UNIX environment no " "POSIX IDs are available for those objects." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><para> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:259 msgid "" "The SID name space is organized in authorities which can be seen as " "different domains. The authorities for the Well-Known SIDs are" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:262 msgid "Null Authority" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:263 msgid "World Authority" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:264 msgid "Local Authority" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:265 msgid "Creator Authority" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:266 msgid "NT Authority" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><para><itemizedlist><listitem><para> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:267 msgid "Built-in" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><para> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:269 msgid "" "The capitalized version of these names are used as domain names when " "returning the fully qualified name of a Well-Known SID." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><refsect2><para> #: include/ldap_id_mapping.xml:273 msgid "" "Since some utilities allow to modify SID based access control information " "with the help of a name instead of using the SID directly SSSD supports to " "look up the SID by the name as well. To avoid collisions only the fully " "qualified names can be used to look up Well-Known SIDs. As a result the " "domain names <quote>NULL AUTHORITY</quote>, <quote>WORLD AUTHORITY</quote>, " "<quote> LOCAL AUTHORITY</quote>, <quote>CREATOR AUTHORITY</quote>, <quote>NT " "AUTHORITY</quote> and <quote>BUILTIN</quote> should not be used as domain " "names in <filename>sssd.conf</filename>." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <varlistentry><term> #: include/param_help.xml:3 msgid "<option>-?</option>,<option>--help</option>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <varlistentry><listitem><para> #: include/param_help.xml:7 include/param_help_py.xml:7 msgid "Display help message and exit." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <varlistentry><term> #: include/param_help_py.xml:3 msgid "<option>-h</option>,<option>--help</option>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <listitem><para> #: include/debug_levels.xml:3 msgid "" "SSSD supports two representations for specifying the debug level. The " "simplest is to specify a decimal value from 0-9, which represents enabling " "that level and all lower-level debug messages. The more comprehensive option " "is to specify a hexadecimal bitmask to enable or disable specific levels " "(such as if you wish to suppress a level)." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <listitem><para> #: include/debug_levels.xml:10 msgid "Currently supported debug levels:" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <listitem><para> #: include/debug_levels.xml:13 msgid "" "<emphasis>0</emphasis>, <emphasis>0x0010</emphasis>: Fatal failures. " "Anything that would prevent SSSD from starting up or causes it to cease " "running." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <listitem><para> #: include/debug_levels.xml:19 msgid "" "<emphasis>1</emphasis>, <emphasis>0x0020</emphasis>: Critical failures. An " "error that doesn't kill the SSSD, but one that indicates that at least one " "major feature is not going to work properly." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <listitem><para> #: include/debug_levels.xml:26 msgid "" "<emphasis>2</emphasis>, <emphasis>0x0040</emphasis>: Serious failures. An " "error announcing that a particular request or operation has failed." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <listitem><para> #: include/debug_levels.xml:31 msgid "" "<emphasis>3</emphasis>, <emphasis>0x0080</emphasis>: Minor failures. These " "are the errors that would percolate down to cause the operation failure of 2." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <listitem><para> #: include/debug_levels.xml:36 msgid "" "<emphasis>4</emphasis>, <emphasis>0x0100</emphasis>: Configuration settings." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <listitem><para> #: include/debug_levels.xml:40 msgid "<emphasis>5</emphasis>, <emphasis>0x0200</emphasis>: Function data." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <listitem><para> #: include/debug_levels.xml:44 msgid "" "<emphasis>6</emphasis>, <emphasis>0x0400</emphasis>: Trace messages for " "operation functions." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <listitem><para> #: include/debug_levels.xml:48 msgid "" "<emphasis>7</emphasis>, <emphasis>0x1000</emphasis>: Trace messages for " "internal control functions." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <listitem><para> #: include/debug_levels.xml:53 msgid "" "<emphasis>8</emphasis>, <emphasis>0x2000</emphasis>: Contents of function-" "internal variables that may be interesting." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <listitem><para> #: include/debug_levels.xml:58 msgid "" "<emphasis>9</emphasis>, <emphasis>0x4000</emphasis>: Extremely low-level " "tracing information." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <listitem><para> #: include/debug_levels.xml:62 msgid "" "To log required bitmask debug levels, simply add their numbers together as " "shown in following examples:" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <listitem><para> #: include/debug_levels.xml:66 msgid "" "<emphasis>Example</emphasis>: To log fatal failures, critical failures, " "serious failures and function data use 0x0270." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <listitem><para> #: include/debug_levels.xml:70 msgid "" "<emphasis>Example</emphasis>: To log fatal failures, configuration settings, " "function data, trace messages for internal control functions use 0x1310." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <listitem><para> #: include/debug_levels.xml:75 msgid "" "<emphasis>Note</emphasis>: The bitmask format of debug levels was introduced " "in 1.7.0." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <listitem><para> #: include/debug_levels.xml:79 msgid "<emphasis>Default</emphasis>: 0" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: outside any tag (error?) #: include/experimental.xml:1 msgid "" "<emphasis> This is an experimental feature, please use http://fedorahosted." "org/sssd to report any issues. </emphasis>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><title> #: include/local.xml:2 msgid "THE LOCAL DOMAIN" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><para> #: include/local.xml:4 msgid "" "In order to function correctly, a domain with <quote>id_provider=local</" "quote> must be created and the SSSD must be running." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><para> #: include/local.xml:9 msgid "" "The administrator might want to use the SSSD local users instead of " "traditional UNIX users in cases where the group nesting (see <citerefentry> " "<refentrytitle>sss_groupadd</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>8</manvolnum> </" "citerefentry>) is needed. The local users are also useful for testing and " "development of the SSSD without having to deploy a full remote server. The " "<command>sss_user*</command> and <command>sss_group*</command> tools use a " "local LDB storage to store users and groups." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <refsect1><para> #: include/seealso.xml:4 msgid "" "<citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sssd</refentrytitle><manvolnum>8</manvolnum> </" "citerefentry>, <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sssd.conf</" "refentrytitle><manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </citerefentry>, <citerefentry> " "<refentrytitle>sssd-ldap</refentrytitle><manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </" "citerefentry>, <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sssd-krb5</" "refentrytitle><manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </citerefentry>, <citerefentry> " "<refentrytitle>sssd-simple</refentrytitle><manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </" "citerefentry>, <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sssd-ipa</" "refentrytitle><manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </citerefentry>, <citerefentry> " "<refentrytitle>sssd-ad</refentrytitle><manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </" "citerefentry>, <phrase condition=\"with_sudo\"> <citerefentry> " "<refentrytitle>sssd-sudo</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </" "citerefentry>, </phrase> <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sss_cache</" "refentrytitle><manvolnum>8</manvolnum> </citerefentry>, <citerefentry> " "<refentrytitle>sss_debuglevel</refentrytitle><manvolnum>8</manvolnum> </" "citerefentry>, <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sss_groupadd</" "refentrytitle><manvolnum>8</manvolnum> </citerefentry>, <citerefentry> " "<refentrytitle>sss_groupdel</refentrytitle><manvolnum>8</manvolnum> </" "citerefentry>, <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sss_groupshow</" "refentrytitle><manvolnum>8</manvolnum> </citerefentry>, <citerefentry> " "<refentrytitle>sss_groupmod</refentrytitle><manvolnum>8</manvolnum> </" "citerefentry>, <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sss_useradd</" "refentrytitle><manvolnum>8</manvolnum> </citerefentry>, <citerefentry> " "<refentrytitle>sss_userdel</refentrytitle><manvolnum>8</manvolnum> </" "citerefentry>, <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sss_usermod</" "refentrytitle><manvolnum>8</manvolnum> </citerefentry>, <citerefentry> " "<refentrytitle>sss_obfuscate</refentrytitle><manvolnum>8</manvolnum> </" "citerefentry>, <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sss_seed</" "refentrytitle><manvolnum>8</manvolnum> </citerefentry>, <citerefentry> " "<refentrytitle>sssd_krb5_locator_plugin</refentrytitle><manvolnum>8</" "manvolnum> </citerefentry>, <phrase condition=\"with_ssh\"> <citerefentry> " "<refentrytitle>sss_ssh_authorizedkeys</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>8</" "manvolnum> </citerefentry>, <citerefentry> " "<refentrytitle>sss_ssh_knownhostsproxy</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>8</" "manvolnum> </citerefentry>, </phrase> <phrase condition=\"with_ifp\"> " "<citerefentry> <refentrytitle>sssd-ifp</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</" "manvolnum> </citerefentry>, </phrase> <citerefentry> <refentrytitle>pam_sss</" "refentrytitle><manvolnum>8</manvolnum> </citerefentry>. <citerefentry> " "<refentrytitle>sss_rpcidmapd</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</manvolnum> </" "citerefentry>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <listitem><para> #: include/ldap_search_bases.xml:3 msgid "" "An optional base DN, search scope and LDAP filter to restrict LDAP searches " "for this attribute type." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <listitem><para><programlisting> #: include/ldap_search_bases.xml:9 #, no-wrap msgid "search_base[?scope?[filter][?search_base?scope?[filter]]*]\n" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <listitem><para> #: include/ldap_search_bases.xml:7 msgid "syntax: <placeholder type=\"programlisting\" id=\"0\"/>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <listitem><para> #: include/ldap_search_bases.xml:13 msgid "" "The scope can be one of \"base\", \"onelevel\" or \"subtree\". The scope " "functions as specified in section 4.5.1.2 of http://tools.ietf.org/html/" "rfc4511" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <listitem><para> #: include/ldap_search_bases.xml:23 msgid "" "For examples of this syntax, please refer to the <quote>ldap_search_base</" "quote> examples section." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <listitem><para> #: include/ldap_search_bases.xml:31 msgid "" "Please note that specifying scope or filter is not supported for searches " "against an Active Directory Server that might yield a large number of " "results and trigger the Range Retrieval extension in the response." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <para> #: include/autofs_restart.xml:2 msgid "" "Please note that the automounter only reads the master map on startup, so if " "any autofs-related changes are made to the sssd.conf, you typically also " "need to restart the automounter daemon after restarting the SSSD." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <varlistentry><term> #: include/override_homedir.xml:2 msgid "override_homedir (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: include/override_homedir.xml:16 msgid "UID number" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: include/override_homedir.xml:20 msgid "domain name" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: include/override_homedir.xml:23 msgid "%f" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: include/override_homedir.xml:24 msgid "fully qualified user name (user@domain)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: include/override_homedir.xml:28 msgid "UPN - User Principal Name (name@REALM)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: include/override_homedir.xml:31 msgid "%o" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: include/override_homedir.xml:33 msgid "The original home directory retrieved from the identity provider." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><term> #: include/override_homedir.xml:38 msgid "%H" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <varlistentry><listitem><para><variablelist><varlistentry><listitem><para> #: include/override_homedir.xml:40 msgid "The value of configure option <emphasis>homedir_substring</emphasis>." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <varlistentry><listitem><para> #: include/override_homedir.xml:5 msgid "" "Override the user's home directory. You can either provide an absolute value " "or a template. In the template, the following sequences are substituted: " "<placeholder type=\"variablelist\" id=\"0\"/>" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <varlistentry><listitem><para> #: include/override_homedir.xml:52 msgid "This option can also be set per-domain." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <varlistentry><listitem><para><programlisting> #: include/override_homedir.xml:57 #, no-wrap msgid "" "override_homedir = /home/%u\n" " " msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <varlistentry><listitem><para> #: include/override_homedir.xml:61 msgid "Default: Not set (SSSD will use the value retrieved from LDAP)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <varlistentry><term> #: include/homedir_substring.xml:2 msgid "homedir_substring (string)" msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <varlistentry><listitem><para> #: include/homedir_substring.xml:5 msgid "" "The value of this option will be used in the expansion of the " "<emphasis>override_homedir</emphasis> option if the template contains the " "format string <emphasis>%H</emphasis>. An LDAP directory entry can directly " "contain this template so that this option can be used to expand the home " "directory path for each client machine (or operating system). It can be set " "per-domain or globally in the [nss] section. A value specified in a domain " "section will override one set in the [nss] section." msgstr "" #. type: Content of: <varlistentry><listitem><para> #: include/homedir_substring.xml:15 msgid "Default: /home" msgstr ""